Brown's Chemistry
Brown's Chemistry
Brown's Chemistry
SUBSTANCE
ELEMENTS, COMPOUNDS, MIXTURE separation, CHEMICAL REACTIONS &
EQUATIONS
Section 1.1 Introduction and Some keywords (see also pictures)
1.1a
ATOM
(i) Even as far back as ancient Greece ~500BC philosophers had considered the concept of what
would be formed on continuously dividing matter i.e. what was the smallest 'bit' left of any
substance. In 1808 the English scientist-chemist Dalton proposed his 'atomic theory' - that all matter
was made up of tiny individual units called atoms which could NOT be subdivided into simpler
substances. What is more, he proposed the idea that there were different types of atoms which we
now call 'elements' and combinations of them produce all the different substances which exist. The
different types of atoms are called elements (examples below).
An ATOM is the smallest particle of a substance which can have its own characteristic
properties AND cannot be split into simpler substances.
(ii) BUT, remember atoms are built up of even more fundamental sub-atomic particles - the
electron, proton and neutron. The centre of an atom, called the nucleus, consists of proton and
neutron particles and the electrons move around the nucleus in 'orbital' energy levels. For more
details see the Atomic Structure Notes.
1.1b
MOLECULES and
their representation
A MOLECULE is a larger particle formed by the chemical combination of two or more atoms.
The molecule may be an element e.g. hydrogen formula H2 (H-H, two atoms combined, all atoms
the same)
or
a compound (more examples below) e.g. carbon dioxide formula CO2 (O=C=O, three atoms
combined) and in each case the atoms are held together by chemical bonds. (detailed GCSE
bonding notes and examples)
You can represent molecule in various styles of diagram. For example, you can colour and size
code the atoms of different elements, so in the molecule pictured on the upper left, you can tell
there are five types of atom (elements) and six atoms in total in the molecule.
The second molecule (lower left) shows the molecular structure of ethanol ('alcohol') which
consists of two carbon atoms, six hydrogen atoms and one oxygen atoms.
You will also come across shorthand versions of this diagrammatic style written like
CH3CH2OH and even shorter C2H5OH but using these styles requires much more experience than
is required when first learning the basic principles of chemistry.
Why they are combined in this particular number and order depends primarily on an atoms
combining power (its valency) an advanced concept dealt with in Part 3 equations, formula and
valency.
There are also styles to give a much greater '3D' impression of the shape of a molecule and they
attempt to show the '3D' spatial arrangement of the atoms in a molecule and how the bonds
connect them together.
On the left is the displayed formula of ethane, which shows all the atoms and
individual bonds. Below left is stylised '3D' version of the displayed formula and
you can see how it fits in with the 'ball and stick' (below it) and 'space-filling'
model (below right) diagrams.
Below are three '3D' representations of the hydrocarbon molecule called
ethane.
H I Th Er Ho W Ar
U?
Element Symbolname quizzes:
easier-pictorial! or
harder-no pictures!
CHEMICAL BOND
1.1d
is an example of a 'space-filling'
diagram which gives a more
accurate representation of the
space the molecule actually occupies.
*At a higher level of thinking, all the atoms of the same element, have the same
atomic or proton number. This number determines how many electrons the atom
has, and so ultimately its chemistry. Any atom with 27 protons and electrons is
cobalt! The diagram 60-Co-27 uses advanced notation - all explained on the atomic
structure page.
See also picture diagrams of elements/compounds and mixtures.
Elements are broadly divided by physical and chemical character into metals and nonmetals. A few elements display characteristics of metallic and non-metallic elements and
are referred to as semi-metals or metalloids. Elements can be more highly characterised
and organised in the form of the Periodic Table. All of these points are discussed on the
GCSE Periodic Table notes page.
The variety of chemical substances around you are all due to different combinations of
atoms. Atoms combine or 'connect' together by means of chemical bonds of which there
are various types, but all chemical bonds are based on the attraction of oppositely charged
particles, i.e. the natural attraction of positive and negative particles - a fundamental law of
physics!
1.1e
COMPOUNDS,
FORMULA
and MOLECULE
The result is that millions of different substances (molecules/compounds) can exist because
of the huge variety of atom combinations possible.
KS3 students do NOT need to know about chemical bonding except the idea that they exist
- otherwise, what holds atoms together?
Detailed GCSE bonding notes and examples for ionic, covalent and
metallic bonds,
o and includes a simplified introduction to chemical bonding
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
1.1f
More on formulae
and COMPOUNDS
methane CH4
(i)
and (ii)
The first 'picture' (i) is an example of a displayed formula, in which every
individual atom is shown and how it is bonded ('connected') with other atoms in the
molecule. All the dashes represent the covalent bonds between the atoms in the
molecule. The dashes actually represent an electrical attractive force, but no need
for any detail at all here.
From this diagram you can tell there are four different elements in the molecules
and the number of atoms of each element ...
... there are 4 carbon atoms (C), 8 hydrogen atoms (H), 1 bromine atom (Br) and 1
chlorine atom (Cl) and because there are at least 2 different elements chemically
combined in the molecule or formula, this also tells you it is a compound (see
below for more examples).
A summary of all the atoms in the individual molecule is called the molecular
formula, shown on the right. The number of atoms of each element is shown as a
subscript number in the formula
There are more examples in the next section which discusses the word compound
further.
Also, look at an example where they are used in chemical equations - burning
methane.
Note: A displayed formula is sometimes called a full structural
formula or graphic formula.
ethane C2H6
1.1g
MIXTURE
1.1h
PURE
SUBSTANCE
PURE means that only one substance is present in the material and can be a pure
element or compound.
A simple physical test for purity, and properties that can help identify a substance, is to
measure the boiling point or melting point. Every pure substance melts and boils at a
fixed temperature (though boiling point depends on the ambient air pressure).
If a liquid is pure it should boil at a constant temperature called the boiling point e.g.
o
water boils at 100 C. Unfortunately, up on a very high mountain, at a lower air pressure,
water boils at a constant, but lower temperature and it is difficult to make a good brew of
tea!
o An impure liquid will boil at a higher temperature if it contains a dissolved
o
solid impurity e.g. seawater, containing dissolved salts, boils at over 100 C.
o An impure liquid can initially boil at a lower than the expected temperature, if it
contains a lower boiling point liquid impurity. The boiling then takes place over a
range of temperatures. For example, in the distillation of an alcohol-water mixture
from a fermented yeast-sugar solution mixture, it boils away within a range starting
o
o
at about 79 C (boiling point of alcohol) and the last drops distil over at 100 C
(boiling point of pure water).
1.1i
IMPURE
IMPURE usually means a mixture of mainly one substance plus one or more other
substances physically mixed in.
Some examples are mentioned above, in the discussion on the effect of impurities on the
melting/boiling points of pure substances.
The % purity of a compound is important, particularly in drug manufacture. Any impurities
present are less cost-effective to the consumer and they may be harmful substances.
1.1j
PURIFICATION
1.1k
CHEMICAL
EQUATION
Section 1.2 Particle Picture examples of Elements, Compounds and Mixtures - useful visual images
Detailed notes on the physical 'States of Matter' - gases, liquids and solids - structure and properties
Heating iron and sulphur is classic chemistry experiment to illustrate what is meant by
CHEMICAL CHANGE and you can adapt the general conclusions described at the end of this
section to any chemical reaction.
A mixture of silvery grey iron filings and yellow sulphur powder is made.
The iron can be plucked out with a magnet i.e. an easily achieved physical separation because the
iron and sulphur are not chemically combined yet!
They are still the same iron and sulphur.
However, on heating the mixture, it eventually glows red on its own and a dark grey solid called iron
sulphide is formed. Both observations indicate a chemical change is happening i.e. a new
substance is being formed.
We no longer have iron or sulphur BUT a new compound with different physical properties (e.g.
colour) and chemical properties (unlike iron which forms hydrogen with acids, iron sulphide forms
toxic nasty smelling hydrogen sulphide!).
iron + sulphur (sulfur) ==> iron sulphide (iron sulfide) or in symbols: Fe + S ==> FeS
AND it is no longer possible to separate the iron from the sulphur using a magnet!
Further proof of a new substance formed: The original reactant iron, and the iron sulphide
product, can be shown to be different substances by their reactions with dilute acid.
Iron sulphide also fizzes and dissolves in dilute sulphuric acid to form iron sulphate BUT produces
the 'rotten eggs' smelly gas hydrogen sulphide which gives a black colour with lead ethanoate
paper (old name lead acetate).
iron sulphide + sulphuric acid ==> iron sulphate + hydrogen sulphide
FeS + H2SO4 ==> FeSO4 + H2S
This is NOT to be done by the student, hydrogen sulphide gas is highly poisonous.
If hydrochloric acid is used, the same two colourless gases are produced but the salt formed would
be iron chloride.
So signs that a chemical reaction has happened include:
change in appearance e.g. change in colour or texture.
temperature changes because an energy change has taken place,
change in mass e.g.
some solids when burned in air gain mass in forming the oxide e.g. magnesium forms magnesium
oxide.
some solids lose mass when heated, e.g. carbonates lose carbon dioxide in thermal
decomposition.
and change in the chemical properties of the products compared to the original reactants.
Therefore a chemical change is one in which a new substance is formed, by a process which
is not easily reversed and usually accompanied by an energy (temperature) change.
This is summarised as reactants ==> products as expressed in chemical equations in words or
symbols.
Apart from experiments and preparations in the laboratory, plenty of chemical changes occur in the
home. For a start, you are an extremely complex chemical structure with lots of reactions going on
in your body all the time, but others in the home include ...
Cooking involves both physical and chemical changes, e.g. meat and potato change in both taste
and texture and breakdown chemically to some extent, baking powder breaks down to release
carbon dioxide gas which gives the 'rising action' in the production of cakes etc..
Gas-liquid chromatography (gc/glc/g.l.c.) can be used to analyse liquid mixtures which can be
vapourised (e.g. petrol, blood for alcohol content). The instrument is called a gas chromatograph.
o
o A sample of the substance under investigation is injected and vapourised into a tube containing
a carrier gas (called the mobile phase, it moves). The gas carries the vaporised substance
through a long 'separating' tube or column wound around inside a thermostated oven.
o The substances in the mixture are partially absorbed by an absorbent material held in the or
column (called the immobile phase or stationary phase, which doesn't move), but only
temporarily. However different substances are held back, or 'retained', for different times so that the
mixture separates out in the carrier gas stream.
There is a dynamic equilibrium between the stationary and mobile phases and the
separation of the components of a mixture by chromatography depends on the distribution
of the components in the sample between the mobile and stationary phases.
The column is filled with a porous solid so gas can get through but passes over a large
surface area OR it is coated in a very high boiling organic liquid which can also provide a
large absorbing surface but still allows gas flow.
o The gases emerge from the oven into a detector system which electronically records the different
signal as each substance comes through. A printout or computer display of the results from the gas
chromatograph, called the gas chromatogram, shows a series of peaks in the graph line imposed
on a steady baseline when only the carrier gas is passing through the detector.
o The time it takes for a substance to come through is called the retention time and is unique for
each substance for a particular set of conditions (flow rate, length of separating column, nature of
separating column material, temperature etc.). Generally speaking, the greater the molecular
mass of the mixture molecule, the longer the retention time. This is because the component
molecule - immobile phase intermolecular force of attraction increases with the size of the
component molecule, so it is absorbed/retained temporarily a bit more strongly (see right of
diagram).
o The height of the peak, or more strictly speaking, the area under the peak, is proportional to the
amount of that particular substance in the mixture.
o Therefore it is possible to identify components in a mixture and calculate their relative
proportions in the mixture.
o The chromatogram shown above (right of diagram) illustrates the separation of some alkane
hydrocarbons in petrol (in reality it is far more complicated with dozens of hydrocarbon molecule
peaks on the chromatogram). The different peak heights give the relative proportions i.e. hexane
>pentane > heptane.
o The retention time order follows the trend of increasing molecular mass gives increasing retention
time i.e. in time heptane C7H16 > C6H14 > C5H12
o The gas chromatographic instrument can be calibrated with known amounts of known substances.
So, the timing position of the peak identifies the component X in the gas and the height of
the peak tells you much of X is in the mixture.
2.4 Three techniques used in a particular and separation and purification procedure
e.g. How can we separate a mixture of sand and salt?
or, how do we separate a salt from a salt preparation?
2.4a FILTRATION
2.4b EVAPORATION
2.4c CRYSTALLISATION
2.4d DECANTATION
Decanting is the simplest possible way of separating a liquid (pure or a solution) from an insoluble
3
solid which has a density greater than water (i.e. > 1.0 g/cm ).
The solid-liquid mixture is allowed to stand e.g. in a beaker, until all the solid settles out to the
bottom of the container.
Then the liquid is carefully poured off to leave the insoluble solid behind.
However it is inefficient e.g. a small amount of liquid is always left in the solid residue and very fine
solid particles take some time to settle out and any disturbance of the liquid can mix them in with
the liquid being poured off.
Wine may be served in a decanter to leave the undesirable solids behind - no good for bits of cork
though, they float!
2. The stopper is removed, and the tap is opened so that you can
carefully run the lower grey layer off first into a beaker.
3. This leaves behind the upper yellow layer liquid, so separating the
two immiscible liquids.
MAGNET
Centrifuges and
centrifuging
For any reaction, what you start with are called the reactants, and what you form are called the
products.
So any chemical equation shows in some way the overall chemical change of ...
REACTANTS ==> PRODUCTS, which can be written in words or symbols/formulae.
It is most important you read about formula in an earlier section of this page.
Empirical formula and molecular formula are dealt with on another page.
In the equations outlined below several things have been deliberately simplified. This is to allow the
'starter' chemistry student to concentrate on understanding formulae and balancing chemical
equations. Some teachers may disagree with this approach BUT my simplifications are:
The word 'molecule' is sometimes loosely used to mean a 'formula'.
The real 3D shape of the 'molecule' and the 'relative size' of the different element atoms is ignored.
If the compound is ionic, the ion structure and charge is ignored, its just treated as a 'formula'.
or Fe 1 atom of
or S 1 atom of sulphur (2Fe would mean two atoms, 5S would mean five sulphur atoms
or the formula FeS means one atom of iron is chemically combined with 1 atom of sulphur
to form the compound called iron sulphide
iron + sulphur ==> iron sulphide
on average one atom of iron chemically combines with one atom of iron forming one molecule
of iron sulphide
two elements chemically combining to form a new compound
Fe + S ==> FeS
3.1d(2)
or the formula NaOH means 1 atom of sodium is combined with 1 atom of
oxygen and 1 atom of hydrogen to form the compound called sodium hydroxide
or the formula HCl means 1 atom of hydrogen is combined with 1 atom of chlorine to form
1 molecule of the compound called hydrochloric acid
or the formula NaCl means 1 atom of sodium are combined with 1 atom chlorine to form
the compound called sodium chloride
or the formula H2O means 2 atoms of hydrogen are chemically combined with 1 atom of
oxygen to form the compound called water.
sodium hydroxide + hydrochloric acid ==> sodium chloride + water
the reactants are one molecule of sodium hydroxide and one molecule of hydrochloric acid
the products are one molecule of sodium chloride and one molecule of water
all chemicals involved are compounds
NaOH + HCl ==> NaCl + H2O
NaOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> NaCl(aq) + H2O(l) (with state symbols)
atom balancing, sum left = right: (1Na + 1O + 1H) + (1H + 1Cl) = (1Na + 1Cl) + (2H + 1O)
For a balanced equation on both sides of the equation you should have 1 sodium atom, 1 oxygen
atom, 1 chlorine atom and 2 hydrogen atoms combined in their particular way in the reactants or
products
3.1d(3)
or the formula H2 means 1 molecule of the element called hydrogen made up of two
joined hydrogen atoms
magnesium + hydrochloric acid ==> magnesium chloride + hydrogen
3.1d(4)
or the formula CuCO3 means one formula of the compound called copper
carbonate, made up of one atom of copper is combined with one atom of carbon and three atoms of
oxygen to form the compound copper carbonate
or the formula H2SO4 means one formula of the compound called sulphuric
acid, which is made up of two atoms of hydrogen, one atom of sulphur and four atoms of oxygen
or the formula CuSO4 means one formula of the compound called copper
sulphate which is made up of one atom of copper, one atom of sulphur and four atoms of oxygen
H2O (example 2)
or the formula CO2 means one molecule of the compound called carbon dioxide
which is a chemical combination of one atom of carbon and two atoms of oxygen.
copper carbonate + sulphuric acid ==> copper sulphate + water + carbon dioxide
the reactants are one formula of copper carbonate and one molecule of sulphuric acid
the products are one formula of copper sulphate, one molecule of water and one molecule of
carbon dioxide
all molecules are compounds in this reaction
CuCO3 + H2SO4 ==> CuSO4 + H2O + CO2
CuCO3(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> CuSO4(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) (with state symbols)
balancing sum left = sum right: (1Cu + 1C + 3O) + (2H + 1S + 4O) = (1Cu + 1S + 4O) + (2H + 1O)
+ (1C + 2O)
For a balanced equation on both sides of the equation you should have 1 copper atom, 1 carbon
atom, 7 oxygen atoms, 2 hydrogen atoms, 1 sulphur atom combined in their particular way in the
reactants or products
3.1d(5)
or the formula CH4 means one molecule of the compound called methane
which is made of one atom of carbon combined with four atoms of hydrogen
or 2O2 means two separate molecules of the element called oxygen, and
each oxygen molecule consists of two atoms of oxygen
CO2 (see also example 4)
Using displayed formula the equation would look like this ...
... in which every individual atom is shown and how it is bonded ('connected') with other atoms in the
molecule. All the dashes represent the covalent bonds between the atoms in the molecules.
3.1d(6)
or the formula Mg(OH)2 is the compound magnesium hydroxide made up of
one magnesium, two oxygen and two hydrogen atoms BUT the OH is a particular combination called
hydroxide within a compound, so it is best to think of this compound as a combination of an Mg and
two OH's, hence the use of the ( ). The subscripted 2 doubles everything in the brackets.
one formula of magnesium hydroxide reacts with two molecules of nitric acid to form one
formula of magnesium nitrate and two molecules of water (all compounds)
Mg(OH)2 + 2HNO3 ==> Mg(NO3)2 + 2H2O
Mg(OH)2(aq) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> Mg(NO3)2(aq) + 2H2O(l) (with state symbols)
atom balancing, sum left = sum right: (1Mg + 2O + 2H) + 2 x (1H + 1N + 3O) = (1Mg + 2N + 6O) +
2 x (2H + 1O)
For a balanced equation on both sides of the equation you should have 1 magnesium atom, 8 oxygen
atoms, 4 hydrogen atoms, 2 nitrogen atoms combined in their particular way in the reactants or
products
3.1d(7)
or the formula Al2O3 means one formula of the compound
called aluminium oxide, made up of two atoms of aluminium Al and three atoms of oxygen O
or 3H2SO4 meaning
three molecules of the compound called sulphuric acid (see also example 4)
one formula of aluminium oxide reacts with three molecules of sulphuric acid
to form one formula of aluminium sulphate and three molecules of water
note the first use of numbers (3) for the sulphuric acid and water!
so picture three of them in your head, otherwise the picture gets a bit big!
Al2O3 + 3H2SO4 ==> Al2(SO4)3 + 3H2O
Al2O3(s) + 3H2SO4(aq) ==> Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 3H2O(l) (with state symbols)
atom balancing, sum left = sum right: (2Al + 3O) + 3 x (2H + 1S + 4O) = (2Al + 3S + 12O) + 3 x
(2H + 1O)
For a balanced equation on both sides of the equation you should have 2 aluminium atoms, 15
oxygen atoms, 6 hydrogen atoms, 3 sulfur atoms combined in their particular way in the reactants or
products
3+
2-
ammonia
(aq)
but the spectator ions are nitrate NO3 and sodium Na which do not change at all,
so the ionic equation is simply: Ag
(aq)
Note that ionic equations omit ions that do not change there chemical or physical state.
-
(aq))
BUT the aqueous silver ion, Ag (aq), combines with the aqueous chloride ion, Cl (aq), to form the
insoluble salt silver chloride, AgCl(s), thereby changing their states both chemically and physically.
(b) Lead(II) iodide, a yellow precipitate (insoluble in water!) can be made by
mixing lead(II) nitrate solution with e.g. potassium iodide solution.
lead(II) nitrate + potassium iodide ==> lead(II) iodide + potassium nitrate
Pb(NO3)2(aq) + 2KI(aq) ==> PbI2(s) + 2KNO3(aq)
which can be written as
Pb
2+
(aq)
+ 2NO3 (aq) + 2K
(aq)
2+
(aq)
+ 2NO3 (aq)
(aq)
Ca
(aq)
ionically: Ca
2-
(aq)
+ CO3
(aq)
(aq)
+ 2Cl (aq)
==> CaCO3(s)
-
Ba
(aq)
+ 2Cl (aq) + 2H
2+
ionic equation: Ba
2-
(aq) +
SO4
(aq)
2-
(aq)
+ SO4
(aq)
==> BaSO4(s) + 2H
(aq)
+ 2Cl (aq)
==> BaSO4(s)
-
2-
Mg(s) + Fe SO4
2+
(aq)
2-
==> Mg SO4
(aq)
+ Fe(s)
2-
The sulphate ion SO4 (aq) is the spectator ion, because it doesn't change in the reaction and can be
omitted from the ionic equation. No electrons show up in the full equations because electrons
lost by Mg must equal the electrons gained by Fe.
so the ionic-redox equation is
Mg(s) + Fe
2+
==> Mg
(aq)
2+
(aq)
+ Fe(s)
2+
(aq)
2+
(aq)
+
(aq)
==> Zn
2+
(aq)
+ H2(g)
+
Zinc atoms, Zn, oxidised by electron loss and hydrogen ions, H , are reduced by electron gain
(c) copper + silver nitrate ==> silver + copper(II) nitrate
Cu(s) + 2AgNO3(aq) ==> 2Ag + Cu(NO3)2(aq)
-
+
(aq)
==> 2Ag(s) + Cu
2+
(aq)
+
e.g. 2[resin] H
2+
(s)
+ Ca
(aq)
2+
(aq)
or 2[resin] Na
(s)
+ Mg
2+
(aq)
2+
(aq)
etc.
(5) Scum formation with hard water: On mixing hard water with soaps made from the sodium salts
of fatty acids, insoluble calcium or magnesium salts of the soap are formed as a grey precipitate ...
CaSO4(aq) + 2C17H35COONa(aq) ==> (C17H35COO)2Ca(s for scum!) + Na2SO4(aq)
or more simply ionically: Ca
2+
(aq)
2-
2+
(s)
3.2a Introduction
What is valency? How do you use valency to work out the formula of a compound?
The valency of an atom or group of atoms is its numerical combining power with other atoms or
groups of atoms.
i.e. its numerical capacity to combine with other atoms.
The theory behind this, is all about stable electron structures!
The combining power or valency is related to the number of outer electrons.
You need to consult the page on "Bonding" to get the electronic background.
A group of atoms, which is part of a formula, with a definite composition, is sometimes
referred to as a radical.
In the case of ions, the charge on the ion is its valency or combining power (list below).
To work out a formula by combining 'A' with 'B' the rule is:
number of atom 'A' x valency of 'A' = number of atom 'B' x valency of 'B',
However it is easier perhaps? to grasp with ionic compound formulae.
In the electrically balanced stable formula, the total positive ionic charge must equal the total
negative ionic charge.
number of ion 'A' x charge of ion 'A' = number of ion 'B' x charge of ion 'B' (you ignore charge sign)
Example: As difficult an example as any you will have to work out!
Aluminium oxide consists of aluminium ions Al
3+
number of Al
x charge on Al
3+
3+
2-
= number of O x charge on O
3+
2-
2-
2-
Hydrogen H (1)
Chlorine Cl and other halogens (1)
Oxygen O and sulphur S (2)
Boron B and aluminium Al (3)
Nitrogen (3, 4, 5)
Carbon C and silicon Si (4)
Phosphorus (P 3,5)
'B' (valency)
deduced formula of A + B
1 of carbon C (4)
1 x 4 = 4 x 1 = CH4
1 of nitrogen (3)
1 x 3 = 3 x 1 = NCl3
1 of carbon C (4)
1 x 4 = 2 x 2 = CO2
2-
2+
3+
3+
1 of Ca
sodium oxide
1 of Fe
2+
2+
2-
2+
2 of Fe
2-
3+
2-
2-
Sulphur forms a sulphide (ion S ), oxygen forms an oxide (ion O ), fluorine forms a fluoride (ion F
), chlorine forms a chloride (ion Cl ), bromine a bromide (ion Br ) and iodine an iodide (ion I ).
The other element at the start of the compound name e.g. hydrogen or a metal like sodium,
potassium, magnesium, calcium, etc. usually remains unchanged in simple compounds at KS3GCSE level.
So typical compound names are, sodium sulphide, hydrogen sulphide, magnesium oxide,
potassium fluoride, hydrogen chloride, sodium chloride, calcium bromide, magnesium iodide etc.
However, even at GCSE level the complications will arise e.g.
(i) Where an element can form two different compounds with different formulae with the
same element there needs to be a way of expressing it in the name as well as in the formula e.g.
iron(II) chloride, FeCl2 and iron(III) chloride, FeCl3
copper(I) oxide, Cu2O and copper(II) oxide, CuO
Hear chlorine has a combining power of 1 (valency 1) and oxygen 2 in both compounds.
However, iron can have a valency of 2 or 3 and copper 1 or 2 and these also correspond
2+
3+
+
2+
numerically to the charge on the metal ions in such compounds e.g. Fe and Fe , Cu and Cu .
Therefore the 'Roman numerals' number in () gives the valency of the element in that particular
compound. At a higher academic level this is known as the oxidation state.
(ii) When the non-metal is combined with oxygen to form a negative ion (anion) ion which
combines with a positive ion (cation) from hydrogen or a metal, then the end of the 2nd part of the
name ends in ...ate or ...ite e.g.
When substances which are made of ions are dissolved in water, or melted, they can be broken
down (decomposed) into simpler substances by passing an electric current through them. This
process is called electrolysis. The electrical conducting solution or melt of ions is called the
electrolyte.
When an ionic substance is melted or dissolved in water the ions are free to move about and move
to the electrical contacts called electrodes. The electrodes are usually inert e.g. carbon or platinum.
The electron rich or negative electrode is called the cathode. The electron deficient or positive
electrode is called the anode.
During electrolysis ions move to their oppositely charged electrode.
o Positively charged ions, usually hydrogen or metal ions move to the negative electrode.
2+
Depending on the voltage, the positive ions may be reduced (e.g. Cu ) by electron gain to deposit a
+
metal (eg. Cu) or release hydrogen gas (H2) from hydrogen ions (H ).
o At the same time negatively charged ions move to the positive electrode. The negative ions may be
oxidised by electron loss. This usually results in the release of a non-metallic gas e.g. oxygen (O2) from
hydroxide ions (OH ) or chlorine from chloride ions (Cl )etc.
Electroplating is the process of coating a conducting material with a layer of metal using the process of electrolysis.
The object to be coated is made the negative cathode and dipped into a salt solution of the metal ions of the metal
to form the coating. On passing a low d.c. voltage the metal is deposited on the conducting negative cathode. For
more details see 4th link below.
Anodising a metal, like aluminium, is done by making it the positive anode in an electrolysis system. When the
electrolyte is sulphuric acid solution, the oxygen formed at the anode oxidises the metal surface to make a thicker
metal oxide layer.
For more detailed examples see ..
o Electrolysis of sodium chloride solution
o Extraction of Aluminium
o Purification of copper
o Electroplating
o A more detailed introduction to Electrochemistry
o See also below for oxidation-reduction and electrode equations
EXOTHERMIC CHANGES
o Heat is released or given out to the surroundings by the materials involved, so the temperature
rises.
o chemical change examples involve a new substance being formed and lots of examples (i) to
(vi) below (but they are not always exothermic - see endothermic below).
o physical change examples e.g. condensation, freezing etc. all require the removal of energy from
the material e.g. water, to the surroundings to produce the change in state (its the same as
releasing heat, but it doesn't seem like it!).
Note: Dissolving substances in water can release heat giving a warm/hot solution e.g.
diluting concentrated sulphuric acid.
At KS3-GCSE level this exothermic 'dissolving' is considered a physical change, but at ASA2 level they may be considered a chemical change too!
At a higher level of thinking for exothermic chemical changes: The net energy change when the energy needed
to break bonds in the reactants is less than the energy released when new bonds are formed in the products.
o See also KS4 Science GCSE/IGCSE Chemistry Notes on Energy Changes for more details
A burning or combustion reaction usually means a very fast exothermic reaction where a flame is observed. It
involves a highly energetic oxidation of 'fuels' where the temperature generated is so high the atoms give off light
from the luminous flame zone e.g.
o (i) bunsen flame as methane gas fuel burns ...
methane + oxygen ==> carbon dioxide + water
CH4(g) + 2O2(g) ==> CO2(g) + 2H2O(l)
This is complete combustion with a pale blue flame and the products cannot react any further with
oxygen.
If the oxygen supply is limited the flame is more yellow and can be 'smokey' due to soot formation
(C) and dangerous since carbon monoxide (CO) can be formed.
These are examples of incomplete combustion.
methane + oxygen ==> carbon monoxide + water
2CH4(g) + 3O2(g) ==> 2CO(g) + 4H2O(l) (carbon monoxide formation)
Most people who die in house fires are poisoned by carbon monoxide (and other
toxic gases) in the thick smoke rather than from burns.
or
methane + oxygen ==> carbon (soot) + water
CH4(g) + O2(g) ==> C(s) + 2H2O(l) (soot formation)
The sooty carbon particles e.g. in a candle flame, are heated to such a high temperature
they become incandescent and give out yellow light, but as far as I know virtually no carbon
monoxide is formed!
See also KS4 Science GCSE/IGCSE Chemistry Notes on fossil fuel combustion
o (ii) passing chlorine over hot aluminium metal to make aluminium chloride, the aluminium burns to form the
chloride ...
aluminium + chlorine ==> aluminium chloride
2Al(s) + 3Cl2(g) ==> 2AlCl3(s)
o (iii) burning magnesium ribbon with a bright white flame ...
magnesium + oxygen ==> magnesium oxide
2Mg(s) + O2(g) ==> 2MgO(s)
o (i) to (iii) are all oxidation reactions, as are all 'fuel' burning reactions.
Continuous combustion requires the 'fire triangle' of heat + fuel + oxidant (oxidants like
oxygen, air or other reactive gases like chlorine or fluorine and in rockets liquids like hydrogen peroxide)
o Very fast or explosive combustion:
A roaring bunsen flame (of methane burning) is an example of fast combustion and when the air
(oxygen) - methane (natural gas) mixture is first ignited it is a small explosion! (equation above). It
seems contradictory, but a source of ignition is needed because the C-H and O=O bonds are very
strong giving a high activation energy. However, once ignited, the heat from the flame keeps the
burning going.
Another explosive example is the 'squeaky pop test for hydrogen'. When a lit splint is applied there
is a faint blue flame for a fraction of a second as the two gases explode to form water + heat, light
and sound energy!
hydrogen + oxygen ==> water
2H2(g) + O2(g) ==> 2H2O(l)
In all these cases the high temperature reaction zone is seen as flame and an initial high energy
source for ignition is needed to initiate the reaction e.g. a match or an electrical discharge.
o Slow or smouldering combustion:
In these cases no flame is seen, but a high temperature heat source is still required to start the
reaction and the reaction zone is still at a high temperature e.g. the red hot slow burning of charcoal
(mainly carbon), but the main combustion product is still carbon dioxide. You can only get this
slow/smouldering combustion with solid combustible reactants.
Gases will tend to explode unless controlled in a burner and liquids will vaporise in the heat from the
flame and so will also burn very fast with a flame.
carbon + oxygen ==> carbon dioxide
ENDOTHERMIC CHANGES
o Heat is absorbed or taken in by the materials involved from the surroundings, the system cools or has to
be heated to effect the change.
o Chemical change examples of endothermic reactions e.g. thermal decomposition of limestone, cracking oil
fractions, decomposition by electrolysis etc.
(i) Photosynthesis: input of energy from sunlight needed
carbon dioxide + water ==> glucose + oxygen
6CO2 + 6H2O + sunlight energy ==> C6H12O6 + 6O2
o
(ii) Making lime by heating limestone to over 900 C where a net input/absorption of energy is
needed to bring about this thermal decomposition ...
limestone ==> quicklime + carbon dioxide
calcium carbonate ==> calcium oxide + carbon dioxide
CaCO3(s) ==> CaO(s) + CO2(g)
(iii) Cracking hydrocarbon molecules from oil to make smaller molecules, also requires this
absorption of heat by the reactant molecules to break em' up', or to put it 'poshly', another example
thermal decomposition e.g.
hexane => ethene + butane
C6H14 ==> C2H4 + C4H10
o Physical change examples e.g. melting, boiling, evaporation etc. all require the input of energy to effect the
change of state of the material.
Note: Dissolving substances in water can absorb heat giving a cool solution e.g. dissolving
ammonium nitrate salt in water.
At KS3-GCSE level this endothermic 'dissolving' is considered a physical change, but at
AS-A2 level they may be considered a chemical change too!
At a higher level of thinking for endothermic chemical changes. The net energy change when the energy
needed to break bonds in the reactants is more than the energy released when new bonds are formed in the
products.
See also KS4 Science GCSE/IGCSE Chemistry Notes on fossil fuel combustion
Decomposition in general means to break down into small species e.g. natural organic matter decomposes with
enzymes into carbon dioxide, water and nitrogen etc.
o Fermentation is form of biological degradation, catalysed by enzymes, to break down glucose sugar into the
smaller molecules of ethanol ('alcohol') and carbon dioxide ...
C6H12O6(aq) ==> 2C2H5OH(aq) + 2CO2(g)
Light can cause decomposition e.g. in photography is a sort of photo-decomposition.
o silver chloride + light ==> silver + chlorine
o 2AgCl ==> 2Ag + Cl2
Thermal decomposition means to break down substances into two or more substances by heat (usually
endothermic reactions at temperatures well above room temperature) e.g.
o The decomposition of calcium carbonate (limestone) into calcium oxide (lime) and carbon dioxide in a high
temperature lime kiln.
o calcium carbonate ==> calcium oxide + carbon dioxide
o CaCO3(s) ==> CaO(s) + CO2(g)
For more details see the Extra Industrial Chemistry notes.
o The breaking down of hydrocarbons into smaller ones using a catalyst as well as a high temperature. This
reaction is also known as cracking.
For more details see the Oil and its useful Products notes.
o e.g. octane ==> hexane + ethene
C8H18 ==> C6H14 + C2H4
o Other thermal decompositions which are examples of reversible reactions.
(2) CH4 + O2 ==> CO2 + 2H2O [burning methane to water and (2) Fe2O3 + 3CO ==> Fe + 3CO2 [iron(III) oxide ore is
carbon dioxide, methane oxidised as the C and H atoms gain reduced to iron metal by oxygen loss in the blast furnace]
O]
(3) 2CO + 2NO ==> CO2 + N2 [nitrogen monoxide reduced to
(3) 2NO + O2 ==> 2NO2 [nitrogen monoxide is oxidised to
nitrogen by losing oxygen]
nitrogen dioxide by gaining oxygen]
(4) CuO + Mg ==> Cu + MgO [loss of oxygen from copper(II)
22(4) SO3 + [O] ==> SO4 [oxidising the sulphite ion to
oxide shows it to be reduced to copper atoms]
the sulphate ion]
The loss or removal of electrons from an atom, ion or
molecule e.g.
2+
(1) Fe ==> Fe
iron(II) ion]
2+
3+
(2) Fe ==> Fe
the iron(III) ion]
-
3+
2+
halogen displace]
2.
3.
4.
5.
2.
3.
4.
5.
POLYMERISATION
means joining many small molecules called monomers into a long molecules of many units called a polymer and
there are two principal types of polymerisation process
(1) Addition polymers are formed by (e.g. alkene) monomers adding together and forming no other products except the
polymer e.g. two examples of addition polymerisation are
ethene ==> poly(ethene)
phenylethene ==> poly(phenylethene), old name polystyrene
(2) Condensation polymers are formed by one or more monomers add together, forming the polymer BUT in forming
the polymer small molecules are eliminated 'between' the monomers e.g. two examples of condensation polymerisation are
...
dicarboxylic acid + diol ==> polyester + water
diamine + dicarboxylic acid ==> nylon + water
(1) Example equations showing addition polymerisation
For more examples and details of addition polymers see Useful Oil Products Part 7
(2) Example equation illustrating condensation polymerisation
NEUTRALISATION
NEUTRALISATION usually involves mixing an acid (pH <7 if soluble) with a base or alkali (pH > 7 if soluble)
which react to form a neutral salt solution of around pH7
Two situations are common:
(1) Water soluble bases, called alkalis and often hydroxides, are mixed with a soluble acid such as hydrochloric,
citric, sulphuric or nitric acid.
o acid + base/alkali ==> salt + water
o e.g. sodium hydroxide + hydrochloric acid ==> sodium chloride + water
NaOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> NaCl(aq) + H2O(l)
o certain carbonates like sodium carbonate, are also soluble to form alkaline solutions, and they will be
similarly neutralised with 'fizzing' as carbon dioxide is formed as a 3rd product
o e.g. sodium carbonate + hydrochloric acid ==> sodium chloride + water + carbon dioxide
Na2CO3(aq) + 2HCl(aq) ==> 2NaCl(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
(2) Dissolving a water insoluble base (often an oxide) in an acid
o e.g. copper oxide + sulphuric acid ==> copper sulphate + water
CuO(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> CuSO4(aq) + H2O(l)
o the acid can also be neutralised with a metal or a carbonate to give a salt solution
o metal + acid ==> salt + hydrogen (this is also a redox reaction)
o e.g. zinc + hydrochloric acid ==> zinc chloride + hydrogen
Zn(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> ZnCl2(aq) + H2(g)
o insoluble carbonate + acid ==> (often soluble) salt + water + carbon dioxide
o e.g. magnesium carbonate + sulphuric acid ==> magnesium sulphate + water + carbon dioxide
MgCO3(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> MgSO4(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
More details of these types of reactions involving acids and bases-alkalis
PRECIPITATION REACTIONS
A precipitation reaction is generally defined as 'the formation of an insoluble solid either by mixing two
solutions or bubbling a gas into a solution.
The silver halide salts are used in photography and can be made by precipitation on mixing solutions of two soluble
salts e.g.
o silver nitrate + potassium chloride ==> silver chloride + potassium nitrate
o AgNO3(aq) + KCl(aq) ==> AgCl(s) + KNO3(aq)
+
o Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) ==> AgCl(s)
+
is the ionic equation (NO3 and K are spectator ions - they don't take part in the reaction)
Insoluble barium sulphate can be made in a similar manner by mixing dilute sulfuric acid with barium chloride
solution
o barium chloride + sulphuric acid ==> barium sulphate + hydrochloric acid
o BaCl2(aq) + H2SO4(aq) ==> BaSO4(s) + 2HCl(aq)
2+
2o Ba (aq) + SO4 (aq) ==> BaSO4(s)
+
is the ionic equation (Cl and H are spectator ions - they don't take part in the reaction)
Calcium carbonate is precipitated when carbon dioxide gas is bubbled into calcium hydroxide solution
o calcium hydroxide + carbon dioxide ==> calcium carbonate + water
o Ca(OH)2(aq) + CO2(g) ==> CaCO3(s) + H2O(l)
Reversible Reactions
Generally speaking most chemical reactions are irreversible, that mean they go 100% one way to the products
and that's that! e.g. magnesium fizzing away in hydrochloric acid to form magnesium chloride and hydrogen. There
is no feasible way of reacting hydrogen and magnesium chloride to re-form magnesium metal and
hydrochloric acid!
However a reversible reaction is a chemical reaction in which the products can be converted back to
reactants under suitable conditions and there are quite a few examples of them.
A reversible reaction is shown by the sign
i.e. a half-arrow to the right (forward reaction) and a half-arrow
to the left (backward reaction).
As pointed out above, most reactions are not reversible and have the usual complete arrow
right i.e. in the direction the reaction goes 100%.
On heating the blue solid, hydrated copper(II) sulphate, steam is given off and the white solid of anhydrous
copper(II) sulphate is formed (left to right reaction).
When the white solid is cooled and water added, blue hydrated copper(II) sulphate is reformed (right to left reaction).
blue hydrated copper(II) sulphate + heat
CuSO4.5H2O(s)
CuSO4(s) + 5H2O(g)
When a reversible reaction occurs in a closed system an equilibrium is formed, in which the original reactants
and products formed coexist.
In an equilibrium there is a state of balance between the concentrations of the reactants and products.
At equilibrium the rate at which the reactants change into products is exactly equal to the rate at which the products
change back to the original reactants.
The result is that that the concentrations of the reactants and products remain the same BUT the reactions don't
stop!
However the relative amounts of the reactants and products depend on the reaction conditions e.g. the temperature
and pressure.
You can change the conditions to favour a particular reaction direction e.g. in a limekiln the carbon dioxide is vented
out so all the limestone changes to lime avoiding an.
(a) The formation of calcium oxide (lime) from calcium carbonate (limestone)
calcium carbonate (limestone)
CaCO3(s)
ammonia
2NH3(g)
o
==>
+ H2O
Example 3: If ethene gas is dissolved in concentrated sulphuric acid and diluted with water, on gentle boiling the
alcohol ethanol is formed (the reverse of example 2). The same reaction occurs if ethene gas and water vapour are
o
passed over a silica gel-phosphoric acid catalyst at 300 C. In both cases the ethene is hydrated to form ethanol
by water addition.
o ethene + water ==> ethanol
o a hydration reaction - also a particular type of an addition reaction
o
+ H2O ==>
Example 4: If white crystalline sugar is heated with concentrated sulphuric acid a spongy mass of carbon is
formed.
o The acid dehydrates the sugar, i.e. it removes the equivalent of 'H2O' and leaves the 'C' atoms!
e.g. glucose ==> carbon + water
C6H12O6 ==> 6C + 6H2O
a dehydration reaction - the removal or elimination of water
Non-metal displacements
Metal displacements
Contact Process
Double
decomposition
This means to coat iron or steel with a layer of zinc to stop it rusting (more details on Metal
Reactivity page)
The synthesis of ammonia by combining nitrogen and hydrogen using high temperature, pressure
and an iron catalyst. (all the details)
Double decomposition is chemical reaction that takes place between two compounds, in which the
first part of one compound combines with the second part of another compound. The bits left over
combine to form the second compound. One of the compounds is usually insoluble.
Catalytic Conversion
(car exhaust)
Esterification
Part of the manufacture of sulphuric acid from: (Full details of Contact Process)
sulphur ==> sulphur dioxide ==V catalyst==> sulphur trioxide* ==> sulphuric acid.
S(s) + O2 (g) ==> SO2 (g), * 2SO2 (g) + O2 (g) ==> 2SO3 (g),
followed by, indirectly, SO3 + H2O ==> H2SO4
where the sulfur trioxide combines with water to form sulfuric acid..
e.g. if you mix solutions of sodium chromate with lead nitrate you get a yellow precipitate of
lead chromate and sodium nitrate is left in solution.
sodium chromate + lead nitrate ==> lead chromate + sodium nitrate
Na2CrO4(aq) + Pb(NO3)2(aq) ==> PbCrO4(s) + 2NaNO3(aq)
This is the yellow pigment Van Gogh used in his paintings and you see it as the road
markings you don't park on!
o
o
Rusting
Substitution
Addition
+
+ H2O
2
Its an equilibrium, /3 rds conversion, and the reaction is catalysed by a few
drops of concentrated sulphuric acid.
Iron (or steel) corrodes more quickly than most other transition metals and readily does so
in the presence of both oxygen (in air) and water to form an iron oxide. This means
rusting is an oxidation reaction.
iron + oxygen + water ==> hydrated iron(III) oxide
4Fe(s) + 3O2(g) + xH2O(l) ==> 2Fe2O3.xH2O(s)
i.e. rust is an orange-brown solid of hydrated iron(III) oxide formed from the reaction with
oxygen and water (the equation is not meant to be balanced and the amount of water x is
variable, from dry to soggy!).
For more details of the chemistry of rusting and its prevention go to the corrosion section on
the Metal Reactivity Series page.
Chemical Synthesis
The word synthesis in chemistry, means to build up a larger molecules from simpler molecules or atoms ...
e.g. iron sulphide is synthesised by heating together iron and sulphur ...
o Fe(s) + S(s) ==> FeS(s)
or The Haber Synthesis of ammonia from its constituent elements ...
o nitrogen + hydrogen ==> ammonia
o N2(g) + 3H2(g) ==> 2NH3(g)
In organic chemistry, usually at more advanced level than GCSE, complex molecules are made by doing a
whole sequence of steps, modifying one molecule to another.
This would be described as a multi-stage synthesis.
Hygroscopic
1. Explaining and how to calculate the relative atomic mass RAM or Ar of an element
How to calculate relative atomic mass
Introduction
Every atom has its own unique relative atomic mass (RAM) based on a standard comparison or relative scale e.g.
it has been based on hydrogen H = 1 amu and oxygen O = 16 amu in the past (amu = relative
atomic mass unit).
The relative atomic mass scale is now based on an isotope of carbon, carbon-12,
,
which is given the value of 12.0000 amu.
o In this standard nuclide notation, the top left number is the mass number (12) and the bottom left number is
the atomic/proton number (6).
In other words the relative atomic mass of an element is now based on the arbitrary value of the carbon-12
isotope being assigned a mass of 12.0000 by international agreement!
o Examples are shown in the Periodic Table diagram above.
o Note
(i) Because of the presence of neutrons in the nucleus, the relative atomic mass is usually at least
double the atomic/proton number because there are usually more neutrons than protons in the
nucleus (mass proton = 1, neutron = 1). Just scan the periodic table above and examine the pairs of
numbers.
You should also notice that generally speaking the numerical difference between the
atomic/proton number and the relative atomic mass tends to increase with increasing atomic
number. This has consequences for nuclear stability.
(ii) For many calculation purposes, relative atomic masses are usually quoted and used at this
academic level to zero or one decimal place eg.
e.g. hydrogen H = 1.0 or ~1, calcium Ca= 40.0 or ~40, chlorine Cl = 35.5, copper Cu = 63.6
or ~64, silver Ag 107.9 or ~108.
Sometimes at A level, values of relative atomic masses may be quoted to two decimal places.
Many atomic masses are known to an accuracy of four decimal places, but for some
elements, isotopic composition varies depending on the mineralogical source, so four
decimal places isn't necessarily more accurate!
In using the symbol Ar for RAM, you should bear in mind that the letter A on its own usually means the mass number
of a particular isotope and amu is the acronym shorthand for atomic mass units.
However there are complications due to isotopes and so very accurate atomic masses are never whole
integer numbers.
Isotopes are atoms of the same element with different masses due to different numbers of neutrons. The very
12
accurate relative atomic mass scale is based on a specific isotope of carbon, carbon-12, C = 12.0000 units
exactly, for most purposes C = 12 is used for simplicity.
For example
hydrogen-1,
hydrogen-2, and
hydrogen-3, are the nuclide notation for the three
isotopes of hydrogen, though the vast majority of hydrogen atoms have a mass of 1. When their accurate isotopic
masses, and their % abundance are taken into account the average accurate relative mass for hydrogen = 1.008,
but for most purposes H = 1 is good enough!
o
See also GCSE/IGCSE/AS Atomic Structure Notes
The strict definition of relative atomic mass (Ar) is that it equals the average mass of all the isotopic atoms
1
present in the element compared to /12th the mass of a carbon-12 atom (relative isotopic mass of 12.0000).
o So, in calculating relative atomic mass you must take into account the different isotopic masses of
the same elements, but also their % abundance in the element.
o Therefore you need to know the percentage (%) of each isotope of an element in order to accurately
calculate the element's relative atomic mass.
o For approximate calculations of relative atomic mass you can just use the mass numbers of the isotopes,
which are obviously all integers ('whole numbers'!) e.g. in the two calculations below.
o To the nearest whole number, isotopic mass = mass number for a specific isotope.
Example 1.3:
(a) Accurate calculation of relative atomic mass (need to know and define what relative isotopic mass is)
1
Relative isotopic mass is defined as the accurate mass of a single isotope of an element compared to /12th the mass of a
carbon-12 atom e.g. the accurate relative isotopic mass of the cobalt-5
is 58.9332
This definition of relative isotopic mass is a completely different from the definition of relative atomic mass, except both are
12
based on the same international standard of atomic mass i.e. 1 unit = 1/12th the mass of a carbon-12 isotope ( C).
If we were to redo the calculation of the relative atomic mass of chlorine (example 1.1 above), which is quite adequate for
GCSE purposes (and maybe A level too), but more accurately at A level, we might do ....
chlorine is 75.77%
35
37
so Ar(Cl) = [(75.77 x 34.9689) + (24.23 x 36.9658)] / 100 = 35.4527 (but 35.5 is usually ok in calculations pre-university!)
See also
Mass Spectrometer and isotope analysis on the GCSE-AS(basic) Atomic Structure Notes, with further RAM
calculations.
(b) Calculations of % composition of isotopes
It is possible to do the reverse of a relative atomic mass calculation if you know the A r and which isotopes are present.
It involves a little bit of arithmetical algebra.
The Ar of boron is 10.81 and consists of only two isotopes, boron-10 and boron-11
The relative atomic mass of boron was obtained accurately in the past from chemical analysis of reacting masses but now
mass spectrometers can sort out all of the isotopes present and their relative abundance.
If you let X = % of boron 10, then 100-X is equal to % of boron-11
Therefore Ar(B) = (X x 10) + [(100-X) x 11)] / 100 = 10.81
so, 10X -11X +1100 =100 x 10.81
-X + 1100 = 1081, 1100 - 1081 = X (change sides change sign!)
therefore X = 19
10
11
so naturally occurring boron consists of 19% B and 81% B (the data books actually quote 18.7 and 81.3, but we didn't
use the very accurate relative isotopic masses)
NOTE: (1) the symbol equation must be correctly balanced to get the right answer! (2) There are good reasons why, when
doing a real chemical preparation-reaction to make a substance you will not get 100% of what you theoretically calculate.
o
o
o
o
o
o
Note: The determination and calculation of the formula of a hydrated salt like MgSO4.7H2O is covered
in Calculations section 14.4.
Calculation of % composition Example 4.4
o Calculate the percentage by mass, of sulfate ion in sodium sulfate
o formula of sodium sulfate Na2SO4, atomic masses: Na = 23, S = 32, O = 16
o Formula mass Na2SO4 = (2 x 23) + 32 + (4 x 16) = 142
2o Formula mass of sulfate ion SO4 (or just SO4 will do for the calculation) = 32 + (4 x 16) = 96
o Therefore % sulfate ion in sodium sulfate = (96/142) x 100 = 67.6% SO4
5. Empirical formula and formula mass from reacting masses (easy start, no moles!)
The EMPIRICAL FORMULA of a compound can be worked out by knowing the exact masses of the elements that combine
to form a given mass of a compound.
The empirical formula of a compound is the simplest whole number ratio of atoms present in a compound. (see
section 3. for some simpler examples). Here the word 'empirical' means from experimental data.
Do not confuse with molecular formula which depicts the actual total numbers of each atom in a molecule.
The molecular formula and empirical formula can be different or the same.
They are the same if the molecular formula cannot be simplified on a whole number basis.
Examples where molecular formula = empirical formula
e.g. sodium sulfate Na2SO4 and propane C3H8
You can simplify the atomic ratios 2 : 1 : 4 or 3 : 8 to smaller whole number (integer) ratios
Examples of where molecular formula and empirical formula are different e.g.
butane molecular formula C4H10, empirical formula C2H5
numerically, the empirical formula of butane is 'half' of its molecular formula
4 : 10 ==> 2 : 5
glucose molecular formula C6H12O6, empirical formula CH2O
1
numerically, the empirical formula of glucose is ' /6th' of the molecular formula
6 : 12 : 6 ==> 1 : 2 : 1
Where the empirical formula and molecular formula are different, you need extra information to deduce the
molecular formula from the empirical formula (see link below).
For more advanced students see Using moles to calculate empirical formula and deduce molecular formula of a
compound/molecule (starting with reacting masses or % composition)
The following examples illustrate the ideas using numbers more easily appreciated than in real experiments.
In real laboratory experiments only a fraction of a gram or a few grams of elements would be used, and a more 'tricky' mole
calculation method is required than shown here (dealt with later for higher students in section 8).
However the examples below show in principal how formulae are worked out from experiments.
Any calculation method must take into account the different relative atomic masses of the elements in order to get to the
actual ratio of the atoms in the formula.
For example, just because 10g of X combines with 20g of Y, it does not mean that the formula of the compound is XY 2 !
Empirical formula calculation Example 5.1 The compound formed between lead and sulfur
o It is found that 207g of lead combined with 32g of sulphur to form 239g of lead sulphide.
o From the data work out the formula of lead sulphide. (Relative atomic masses: Pb = 207 and S = 32)
o In this case it easy to see that by the atomic mass ratio, 239 splits on a 1 to 1 basis of 1 atom of lead to 1
atom of sulphur (1 x 207 to 1 x 32 by mass)
o so the formula is simply PbS
o You can set out the calculation in a simple table format, in this case the numbers are very easy to deal
with!
o
RATIOS ...
Reacting mass
207g
32g
207/207 = 1
32/32 = 1
therefore the integer simplest ratio of 1 : 1 gives the empirical formula for lead sulphide as PbS
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.2 The empirical formula of a lead oxide
o It is found that 207g of lead combined with oxygen to form 239g of a lead oxide.
o From the data work out the formula of the lead oxide. (Relative atomic masses: Pb = 207 and O = 16)
o In this case, you first have to work out the amount of oxygen combined with the lead.
o By simple logic from the law of conservation of mass, this is 239 - 207 = 32g
o In atomic ratio terms, the 207 is equivalent to 1 atom of lead and the 32 is equivalent to 2 atoms of oxygen
(1 x 207 to 2 x 16),
o so the formula is simply PbO2
o Note: The mass of oxygen combined with the lead is deduced by subtracting the original mass of lead from
final total mass of lead oxide.
o
RATIOS ...
Reacting mass
207g
239-207 = 32g
207/207 = 1
32/16 = 2
therefore the simplest whole number ratio of 1 : 2 gives the empirical formula for this lead oxide as PbO2
Its actually called lead(IV) oxide
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.3 The empirical formula of aluminium sulfide
o It is found that 54g of aluminium forms 150g of aluminium sulphide.
o Work out the formula of aluminium sulphide. (Relative atomic masses: Al = 27 and S = 32).
o
o
o
o
o
RATIOS ...
Reacting mass
54g
150-54 = 96g
54/27
96/32
therefore the simplest integer ratio of 2 : 3 gives the empirical formula for aluminium sulphide as Al2S3
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.4: This is a much more elaborate reacting mass calculation
involving solution concentrations to arrive at a formula mass.
o I've used HCl and MOH as shorthand in the question and answers.
o The idea is to use the analysis data to work out the atomic mass of metal M, that forms a hydroxide of
formula MOH.
3
o A solution of hydrochloric contained 3.65 g/dm .
3
o A solution of a metal hydroxide of formula MOH was prepared by dissolving 5.0g of MOH in 1 dm of water
(M is an unknown metal).
3
3
o 25 cm of the MOH solution required 22.3 cm of the HCl acid solution to neutralise it in a titration procedure
using a pipette (MOH) and burette (HCl).
The equation for the neutralisation reaction is: MOH + HCl ==> MCl + H2O
Atomic masses: H = 1, Cl = 35.5, O = 16, M = ?
(a) Calculate the mass of MOH neutralised in each titration.
3
3
5 x 25 / 1000 = 0.125g MOH (remember 1 dm = 1000 cm )
(b) Calculate the mass of HCl reacting in each titration.
3.65 x 22.3 / 1000 = 0.0814 g HCl
(d) Calculate the formula mass of HCl
Formula mass of HCl = 1 + 35.5 = 36.5
(c) Calculate the mass of MOH that reacts with 36.5 g HCl and hence the formula mass of MOH.
If 0.125 g MOH reacts with 0.0814 g HCl
z g MOH reacts with 36.5 g HCl
solving the ratio, z = 36.5 x 0.125 / 0.0814 = 56.1 g MOH
Therefore the experimental formula mass of MOH is 56.1 (~56) because from the equation
1 HCl reacts with 1 MOH.
(d) If the metal is in the Group 1 of Alkali Metals, what is the atomic mass of M and what metal is M?
If the formula mass of MOH is 56, atomic mass of M = 56 - 1 -16 = 39
The atomic mass of potassium is 39, so M is potassium.
(So 'fictitious' MOH is really KOH, potassium hydroxide. You are likely to very familiar with
another in the same group, sodium hydroxide NaOH)
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.5 From now on, questions just using the table method to work out
empirical formula from more awkward numbers! In this case a compound formed between copper and chlorine.
o A compound of copper contained 47.4% copper and 52.6% chlorine.
o The atomic masses are: Cu = 64 and Cl = 35.5
o Think of the percentages as masses in grams to solve the empirical formula problem.
o
RATIOS ...
Cu
Cl
Reacting mass
47.4
52.6
47.4/64 = 0.74
52.6/35.5 = 1.48
0.74/0.74 = 1.0
1.48/0.74 = 2.0
therefore the simplest whole number ratio of 1 : 2 gives the empirical formula for copper chloride as CuCl2
Its actually called copper(II) chloride
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.6 The empirical formula of a compound of carbon and chlorine
o It was found that 0.39 g of carbon was combined with 4.61g of chlorine.
o Atomic masses: C = 12 and Cl = 35.5
o
RATIOS ...
Cl
Reacting mass
0.39
4.61
0.39/12 = 0.0325
4.61/35.5 = 0.130
0.0325/0.0325 = 1.0
Reacting mass
0.75g
0.25g
0.75/12 = 0.0625
0.25/1 = 0.25
0.0625/0.0625 = 1.0
therefore the simplest ratio gives the empirical formula for the hydrocarbon = 1 : 4, so formula is CH4
This is the simplest hydrocarbon molecule called methane (main constituent in natural gas)
o Empirical formula calculation Example 5.8 The analysis of sodium sulfate, calculating its empirical formula
from the % composition by mass.
o On analysis, the salt sodium sulfate was found to contain 32.4% sodium, 22.5% sulfur and 45.1% oxygen.
o Atomic masses: Na = 23, S = 32 and O = 16
o Calculate the empirical formula of sodium sulfate
o
RATIOS ...
Na
Reacting mass
32.4
22.5
45.1
32.4/23 = 1.41
22.5/32 = 0.70
simplest whole
number atom ratio
by trial & error
0.70/0.70 = 1.0
the simplest ratio gives the empirical formula for sodium sulfate = 2 : 1 : 4, formula is Na2SO4
SECTION 6. REACTING MASSES OF REACTANTS AND PRODUCTS AND ACTUAL PERCENT % YIELD,
THEORETICAL YIELD AND ATOM ECONOMY
CALCULATING MASSES IN REACTIONS
How do we calculate mass of products formed? How do we calculate mass of reactants needed?
comments
2Mg
==>
2MgO
2 x 24 = 48g
==>
2 x 40 = 80g
1g
==>
80/48 = 1.667g
2 x 1 = 2g
==>
2 x 1.667 = 3.334g
comments
2NaOH
==>
Na2SO4
2 x 40 = 80 g
==>
142 g
80/142 = 0.563 g
==>
142/142 = 1.0 g
5.0 x 0.563 =
2.82g
==>
Therefore you need 2.82g of sodium hydroxide to make 5.00g of sodium sulfate
o
o
o
(b) calculate how much water is formed when 10g of sulphuric acid reacts with sodium hydroxide.
from the reacting mass equation: 98g of H2SO4 forms 36g of H2O
10g of H2SO4 forms 10g x 36 / 98 = 3.67g of H2O by scaling down from 98 => 10
You can solve reacting mass problems (i.e. solve the ratio problem) with a series of logical steps
set out in a table illustrated and explained below ...
Pick out the particular ratio you need to solve the
reacting mass problem e.g. the particular reactant
and product
H2SO4
==>
2H2O
comments
98g
==>
2 x 18 = 36g
1g
==>
36/98 = 0.367g
10 x 1 = 10g
==>
10 x 0.367 = 3.67g
Therefore 3.67g of water is formed when 10g of sulfuric acid reacts with sulfuric acid
comments
==>
2Cu
12 tonne
==>
2 x 64 = 128 tonne
12/128 = 0.09375
tonne
==>
16 x 0.09375 =
1.50 tonne
==>
16 x 1.0 = 16 tonne
Therefore 1.50 tonne of carbon is needed to reduce 16 tonne of copper oxide to copper
o
o
o
(b) How many tonne of copper can be made from 800 tonne of copper oxide ore?
from the reacting mass equation: 160 of CuO makes 128 of Cu (or direct from formula 80 CuO ==> 64 Cu)
scaling up numerically: mass copper formed = 800 x 128 / 160 = 640 tonne Cu
You can solve reacting mass problems (i.e. solve the ratio problem) with a series of logical steps
set out in a table illustrated and explained below ...
Pick out the particular ratio you need to solve the
reacting mass problem e.g. the particular reactant
comments
and product
2CuO
==>
2Cu
2 x 80 = 160
tonne
==>
2 x 64 = 128 tonne
1 tonne
==>
128/160 = 0.80
tonne
800 x 1 = 800
tonne
==>
Therefore 640 tonne of copper can be extracted from 800 tonne of copper(II) oxide
comments
Fe2O3
3C
160 tonne
3 x 12 = 36 tonne
160/160 = 1.0
tonne
36/160 = 0.225
tonne
20 x 1.0 = 20.0
tonne
20 x 0.225 = 4.5
tonne
Therefore 4.5 tonne of carbon is needed to reduce 20 tonne of the iron oxide
o
o
o
o
o
o
(a) Theoretically how much copper can be obtained from 2000 tonne of pure chalcopyrite ore,
formula CuFeS2 ?
Chalcopyrite is a copper-iron sulphide compound and one of the most important and common ores
containing copper.
Atomic masses: Cu = 64, Fe = 56 and S = 32
For every one CuFeS2 ==> one Cu can be extracted, formula mass of ore = 64 + 56 + (2x32) = 184
Therefore the reacting mass ratio is: 184 ==> 64
so, solving the ratio ...
2000 CuFeS2 ==> 2000 x 64 / 184 Cu = 695.7 tonne copper
This is the maximum amount of copper that can be theoretically extracted from the 'pure'
ore.
In reality there are impurities in the ore (e.g. other minerals) and in the extracted molten
copper.
You can solve reacting mass problems (i.e. solve the ratio problem) with a series of logical steps
set out in a table illustrated and explained below ...
Pick out the particular ratio you need to solve the
reacting mass problem e.g. the particular reactant
and product
CuFeS2
==>
comments
Cu
184 tonne
==>
64 tonne
184/184 = 1.0
tonne
==>
64/184 = 0.3478
tonne
2000 x 1.0 =
2000 tonne
==>
2000 x 0.0.3478 =
695.6 tonne
Therefore 695.6 tonne of copper can be extracted from 2000 tonne of chalcopyrite copper ore
(b) If only 670.2 tonne of pure copper is finally obtained after further purification of the extracted
copper by electrolysis, what is the % yield of the overall process?
o % yield = actual yield x 100/theoretical yield
o % yield = 100 x 670.2 / 695.7 = 96.3%
o More on % yield and atom economy in calculations section 14.
o Reacting mass calculation Example 6a.6
o Calculating the theoretical yield of iron from an impure iron oxide ore.
o A sample of magnetite iron ore contains 76% of the iron oxide compound Fe 3O4
and 24% of waste silicate minerals.
o (a) What is the maximum theoretical mass of iron that can be extracted from each tonne (1000 kg) of
magnetite ore by carbon reduction? [ Atomic masses: Fe = 56, C = 12 and O = 16 ]
o The reduction equation is: Fe3O4 + 2C ==> 3Fe + 2CO2
o Before doing the reacting mass calculation, you need to do simple calculation to take into account the lack of
purity of the ore.
o 76% of 1 tonne is 0.76 tonne (760 kg).
o For the reacting mass ratio: 1 Fe3O4 ==> 3 Fe (you can ignore rest of equation)
o Therefore in reacting mass units: (3 x 56) + (4 x 16) ==> 3 x 56
o so, from the reacting mass equation: 232 Fe3O4 ==> 168 Fe
o 0.76 Fe3O4 tonne ==> x tonne Fe
o solving the ratio, x = 0.76 x 168/232 = 0.55
o = 0.55 tonne Fe (550 kg)/tonne (1000 kg) of magnetite ore
o o (b) What is the atom economy of the carbon reduction reaction?
o You can use some of the data from part (a).
o % atom economy = 00 x total mass of useful product / total mass of products
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Because of the law on conservation of mass, total mass reactants = total mass of reactants
% atom economy = 100 x total mass of useful product / total mass of products
It doesn't matter which version you use for the atom economy calculation, you should get the same answer!
= 100 x 168 / (232 + 2x12) = 100 x 168/256 = 65.6%
More on % yield and atom economy in calculations section 14.
(c) Will the atom economy be smaller, the same, or greater, if the reduction involves carbon
monoxide (CO) rather than carbon (C)? explain?
o The atom economy will be smaller because CO is a bigger molecular/reactant mass than C and 4
molecules would be needed per 'molecule' of Fe3O4, so the mass of reactants is greater for the same
product mass of iron (i.e. bottom line numerically bigger, so % smaller). This is bound to be so because the
carbon in CO is already chemically bound to some oxygen and can't remove as much oxygen as carbon
itself.
o Fe3O4 + 4CO ==> 3Fe + 4CO2
o so the atom economy = 100 x 168 / (232 + 4x28) = 48.8 %
o Note reactants mass (232 + 4x28) = (3x56 + 4x44) products mass
o More on % yield and atom economy in calculations section 14.
o Reacting mass calculation Example 6a.7
o Deposition from hard water samples
o On analysis, a sample of hard water was found to contain 0.056 mg of calcium
3
hydrogen carbonate per cm (0.056 mg/ml).
o If the water is boiled, calcium hydrogencarbonate Ca(HCO 3)2, decomposes to give a precipitate of
calcium carbonate CaCO3, water and carbon dioxide.
o (a) Give the symbol equation of the decomposition complete with state symbols.
Ca(HCO3)2(aq) ==> CaCO3(s) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
3
3
o (b) Calculate the mass of calcium carbonate in grammes deposited if 2 litres (2 dm , 2000 cm or ml)
is boiled in a kettle.
[ atomic masses: Ca = 40, H = 1, C = 12, O = 16 ]
the relevant ratio is based on: Ca(HCO3)2 ==> CaCO3
The formula masses are 162 (40x1 + 1x2 + 12x2 + 16x6) and 100 (40 + 12 + 16x3) respectively
there the reacting mass ratio is 162 units of Ca(HCO3)2 ==> 100 units of CaCO3
3
the mass of Ca(HCO3)2 in 2000 cm (ml) = 2000 x 0.056 = 112 mg
therefore solving the ratio 162 : 100 and 112 : z mg CaCO 3
where z = unknown mass of calcium carbonate
z = 112 x 100/162 = 69.1 mg CaCO3
since 1g = 1000 mg, z = 69.1/1000 = 0.0691 g CaCO3, calcium carbonate
o (c) Comment on the result, its consequences and why is it often referred to as 'limescale'?
This precipitate of calcium carbonate will cause a white/grey deposit to be formed on the side of the
kettle, especially on the heating element.
Although 0.0691 g doesn't seem much, it will build up appreciably after many cups of tea!
The precipitate is calcium carbonate, which occurs naturally as the rock limestone, which dissolved
in rain water containing carbon dioxide, to give the calcium hydrogen carbonate in the first place.
Since the deposit of 'limestone' builds up in layers it is called 'limescale'.
o Reacting mass calculation Example 6a.8
o This is a much more elaborate reacting mass calculation involving solution
concentrations and extended ideas from the results.
o In this exemplar Q I've used the formulae a lot for short-hand.
3
o A solution of hydrochloric contained 7.3 g HCl/dm .
3
o A solution of a metal hydroxide of formula MOH was prepared by dissolving 4.0g of MOH in 250 cm of
water.
+
3
o M is an unknown metal but it is known that the ionic formula of the hydroxide is M OH . 25cm samples of
the MOH solution were pipetted into a conical flask and titrated with the hydrochloric solution using a burette
and a few drops of phenolphthalein indicator.
o All the MOH is neutralised as soon as the pink indicator colour disappears (i.e. the indicator becomes
colourless).
3
3
o On average 19.7 cm of the HCl acid solution was required to completely neutralise 25.0 cm of the MOH
solution.
o [Atomic masses: H = 1, Cl = 35.5, O = 16, M = ?]
(a) Give the equation for the reaction between the metal hydroxide and the hydrochloric acid.
MOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> MCl(aq) + H2O(l)
You may or may not be required to give the state symbols in (), or you may be just asked to
complete the equation given part of it.
(b) Calculate the mass of HCl used in each titration.
3
3
3
1 dm = 1000 cm , so in 19.7 cm of the HCl solution there will be
19.7 x 7.3 / 1000 = 0.1438 g HCl
(c) Calculate the mass of MOH that reacts with the mass of HCl calculated in (b).
3
3
25cm of the 250 cm MOH solution was used, so the mass of MOH titrated is
o Reacting mass calculation 6a.9, including calculating atom economy and percentage yield
o The displacement reaction between iron and copper(II) sulfate solution
o (a) Write out the equation for this reaction
You can write the equation out in several different ways, and any can be used to do a reacting mass
calculation
Fe + CuSO4 ==> Cu + FeSO4 (simple 'molecular' equation)
Fe(s) + CuSO4(aq) ==> Cu(s) + FeSO4(aq) (with state symbols)
2+
2+
Fe + Cu ==> Cu + Fe (ionic equation)
2+
2+
Fe(s) + Cu (aq) ==> Cu(s) + Fe (aq) (ionic equation with state symbols)
o (b) Calculate the maximum amount of copper that can be displaced by 2.8g of iron?
Atomic masses: Fe = 56, Cu = 64, S = 32, O =16
From the equation 1 atom of iron displaces 1 atom of copper,
therefore 56g of iron will displace 64g of copper
therefore 2.8g of iron will displace x g of copper
by scaling down
x = 2.8 x 64/56 = 3.2 g Cu can be theoretically displaced
o (c) What is the atom economy of the reaction based on the ionic equation?
Based on atomic mass units
total mass of products = 64 + 56 = 120
mass of useful product = 64
atom economy = 100 x 64/120 = 53.3 %
More on % yield and atom economy in calculations section 14.
o (d) If only 2.7 g of pure copper was recovered from the experiment, what was the % yield?
% yield = 100 x actual yield/maximum theoretical yield
% yield = 100 x 2.7/3.2 = 84.4%
Reacting mass calculation 6a.10, including calculating atom economy and percentage yield
o The displacement reaction between copper and silver nitrate solution.
o The equation for this reaction is
Cu + 2AgNO3 ==> Cu(NO3)2 + 2Ag
atomic masses: Cu = 64, Ag = 108, N = 14, O = 16
o (a) What is the atom economy of the reaction?
You can add up the total mass of reactants or total mass of products, its all the same (because of
the law of conservation of mass!)
Based on atomic mass units
mass of reactants = 64 + 2 x [108 + 14 + (3 x 16)] = 64 + (2 x 170) = 404
mass of useful product = 2 x 108 = 216
atom economy = 100 x 216/ = 100 x 216/404 = 53.5 %
More on % yield and atom economy in calculations section 14.
o (b) 500g of copper was used to displace silver from a silver nitrate solution.
(i) What is the maximum amount of silver that could be obtained from the process?
From the equation 1 atom Cu ==> 2 atoms silver
therefore 64g Cu ==> 2 x 108 g Ag
SECTION 7. INTRODUCING MOLES - THE CONNECTION OF MOLES, MASS AND FORMULA MASS
(a) WHAT IS THE MOLE CONCEPT? and WHAT IS ONE MOLE OF A SUBSTANCE?
The mole concept is an invaluable way of solving many quantitative problems in chemistry!
Its a very important way of doing chemical calculations!
The theoretical basis is explained in section (b).
The mole is most simply expressed as the relative 'formula mass in g' or the 'molecular mass in g'
of the defined chemical 'species', and that is how it is used in most chemical calculations.
The formula mass in grams = one mole of the defined substance.
One mole of a substance equals the molecular mass in grams.
moles of species = (actual mass of species in g) / (atomic/formula mass of species)
therefore (using triangle on right if necessary)
mass of species in g = moles species x atomic/formula mass of species
atomic/formula mass of species = mass of species in g / moles of species
Note these equations are for either an element or a compound,
but, whatever, you must clearly define the chemical species you mean for any mole calculation e.g.
+
Al metal element atom, H2O covalent molecule, an element O2 molecule, Na Cl ionic compound or just any compound
formula like CuSO4 etc. etc.
Mr is 'shorthand' for relative formula mass or molecular mass in amu (atomic mass units).
The term relative molecular mass (sum of the atomic masses of the atoms in a single molecule of the substance) is usually
applied to definite molecular species
e.g. molecular mass 18 for the water molecule H2O, 17 for the ammonia molecule NH3
16 for the methane molecule CH4 and 180 for the glucose sugar molecule C6H12O6
(atomic masses for these examples H = 1, O = 16, N = 14, C = 12, S = 32, Na = 23, Cl = 35.5)
The term relative formula mass (sum of the atomic masses of the atoms in a specified formula) can be used for ANY
specified formula of ANY chemical substance, though it is most often applied to ionic substances.
+
e.g. mass of 1 mole of ionic sodium chloride NaCl or Na Cl is 58.5g (from 23 + 35.5)
+
2-
mass of 1 mole of ammonium sulfate (ionic salt) (NH4)2SO4 or (NH4 )2(SO4 ) = 130g
or 18g (1 + 1 + 16) for the mass of 1 mole of water H2O, and
17g (14 + 1 + 1 + 1) is the mass of 1 mole of the ammonia molecule NH3
The actual particle number is known and is called the Avogadro Constant, denoted NA).
It is equal to 6.023 x 10
23
23
-1
mol
This means there are that many atoms in 12g of carbon (C = 12)
or that many molecules in 18g water (H2O = 1+1+16 = 18, H = 1; O = 16) *.
3
* This is about 18cm , so picture this number of molecules in a nearly full 20cm measuring cylinder or a 100ml
1
beaker less than /5th full!
The Avogadro number is 6.023 x 10
23
= 602 300 000 000 000 000 000 000 atoms or molecules per mole!
= six hundred and two thousand and three hundred million million million 'particles' per mole !
3
A thimble full of water is about 1cm , 1 mole of water = 18g and ~ 18cm because the density of water is ~1.0 g/cm
23
22
The real importance of the mole is that it allows you to compare ratios of the relative amounts of reactants and products,
or the element composition of a compound, at the atomic and molecular level.
1 mole of any defined chemical species has an identical number of that species to any other defined chemical
species.
If you have a mole ratio for A : B of 1 : 3, it means 1 particle of A to 3 particles of B irrespective of the atomic or formula
masses of A and B.
It also means that you can read equations in terms of a mole ratio
e.g. 2NaOH + H2SO4 ==> Na2SO4 + 2H2O
can be read as 2 moles of sodium hydroxide neutralises 1 mole of sulfuric acid to form 1 mole of the salt sodium sulfate and
2 moles of water,
BUT the equation can be read in terms of any molar quantities, as long as you keep the ratios the same!
1
e.g. by only taking /20th of a mole of sodium hydroxide you can deduce (yes predict!)
0.05 moles of NaOH reacts with 0.025 moles of H2SO4 to form 0.025 moles of Na2SO4 and 0.05 moles of H2O
What more, since you can convert moles to mass, you can do deduce the mass of product formed or the mass of reactants
need.
Also, since you can go from mass to moles, you can deduce equations from measuring reacting masses.
(see also section 6. for reacting masses not using moles)
(c) EXAMPLES OF MOLE CALCULATIONS to illustrate the introduction section (a)
The latter is a better way to look at ammonia formation because nitrogen and hydrogen exist as
diatomic molecules and NOT individual atoms.
o N2(g) + 3H2(g) ==> 2NH3(g)
o You can then think in any ratio you want e.g. 0.05 mol nitrogen combines with 0.15 mol
hydrogen to form 0.10 mol of ammonia.
o So, you can calculate using any mole ratio on the basis of the 1 : 3 : 2 ratio (or 1 : 3 ==> 2) of the reactants
and products in the balanced symbol equation.
Mole calculation Example 7.1.2
o Consider the formation of 1 or 2 moles of aluminium oxide,
o Al2O3, consists of 2 moles of aluminium atoms combined with 3 moles of oxygen atoms (or 1.5 moles
of O2 molecules) to form 1 mole of aluminium oxide.
3
2Al(s) + /2O2(g) ==> Al2O3(s)
o To avoid awkward fractions in equations you can say 4 moles of aluminium atoms combine with exactly 3
moles of oxygen molecules to form 2 moles of aluminium.
4Al(s) + 3O2(g) ==> 2Al2O3(s)
So the simplest whole number reacting mole ratio is 4 : 3 : 2 (or 4 : 3 ==> 2)
Mole calculation Example 7.1.3
o How do you go from a reacting mole ratio to reacting mass ratio?
o You read the equation in relative numbers of moles and convert the moles into mass.
mass moles x formula mass - see triangle on right
e.g. the formation of copper(II) chloride from copper(II) oxide and
hydrochloric acid.
CuO(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> CuCl2(aq) + H2O(l)
1 mole + 2 moles ==> 1 mole + 1 mole
Atomic masses: Cu = 64, O = 16, H = 1, Cl =35.5
Therefore ...
(64 + 16)g CuO + [2 x (1 + 35.5)]g HCl ==> [64 + (2 x 35.5)]g CuCl2 + [(2 x 1) + 16)]g H2O
80g CuO + 73g HCl ==> 135g CuCl2 + 18g H2O
So, from a mole ratio of 1 : 2 ==> 1 : 1
you get a mass ratio of 80 : 73 ==> 135 : 18
Mole calculation Example 7.1.4
o This can be useful for calculating the quantities of chemicals you need for e.g. the chemical preparation of a
compound.
o Using the concept of mole ratio and the exemplar reactions above ...
o (a) Calculate how many grams of copper(II) oxide you need to dissolve in hydrochloric acid to make
0.25 moles of copper(II) chloride?
From the equation, 1 mole of copper oxide makes 1 mole of copper chloride,
therefore you need 0.25 moles of CuO
since mass = mass of 1 mole x formula mass
you need 0.25 x 80 = 20g of CuO
o (b) What mass of aluminium metal do you need to make 0.1 moles of aluminium oxide?
4Al(s) + 3O2(g) ==> 2Al2O3(s) and the atomic mass of aluminium is 27
4 moles of aluminium makes 2 moles of aluminium oxide, (ratio 4:2 or 2:1)
therefore 0.2 moles of aluminium metal makes 0.1 moles of aluminium oxide (keeping the ratio of
2:1)
mass of aluminium metal needed = 0.2 x 27 = 5.4g of Al
o Note that you can pick out the ratio you need to solve a problem - you DON'T need all the numbers of
the full molar ratio, all you do is pick out the relevant ratio!
For calculation purposes learn the following formula for 'Z' and use a triangle if necessary.
(d) More advanced calculations using the Avogadro Constant to illustrate the introduction section (b)
where you can actually calculate the number of particles in known quantity of material !
(e) More advanced use of the mole and Avogadro Number concepts (for advanced level students only)
You can have a mole of whatever you want in terms of chemical species e.g.
23
In terms of electric charge, 1 Faraday = 96500 C (coulombs) = 6 x 10 electrons
If you have 2.5 moles of the ionic aluminium oxide (Al2O3) you have ...
3+
2o 2 x 2.5 = 5 moles of aluminium ions (Al ) and 3 x 2.5 = 7.5 mol of oxide ions (O )
When you write ANY balanced chemical equation, the balancing numbers, including the un-written 1, are the
reacting molar ratio of reactants and products.
Extra Advanced Level Chemistry Questions - more suitable for Advanced AS-A2 students which can be completely
tackled after ALSO studying section 9 on the molar volume of gases and ANSWERS to QA7.1
QA7.1 This question involves using the mole concept and the Avogadro Constant in a variety of situations.
The Avogadro Constant = 6.02 x 10
23
-1
mol
(i) the volume of hydrogen formed when excess zinc is added to 50 cm of hydrochloric acid, concentration 0.2 mol
-3
dm .
3
(j) the volume of carbon dioxide formed when excess calcium carbonate is added to 75 cm of 0.05 mol dm
hydrochloric acid.
-3
numerically, the empirical formula of glucose is ' /6th' of the molecular formula
6 : 12 : 6 ==> 1 : 2 : 1
Where the empirical formula and molecular formula are different, you need extra information to deduce the
molecular formula from the empirical formula (examples set out further on down the page).
Simple empirical formula calculations NOT using moles were covered in section 5.
Examples of where the empirical formula is the same as the molecular formula ...
water H2O, methane CH4, pentane C5H12 (these molecular formula cannot be 'simplified')
Examples of where the molecular formula is different from the empirical formula in () ...
e.g. ethane C2H6 (CH3), phosphorus(V) oxide P4O10 (P2O5), benzene C6H6 (CH)
Three examples are set out below to illustrate all the situations and how to calculate an empirical formula and a
molecular formula from reacting masses or % element composition by mass.
For non-molecular compounds (i.e. inorganic ionic compounds), the empirical formula is usually, but not always, quoted as
the compound formula.
The relative atomic masses of the elements (Ar) are given in the tabular format method of solving the problem.
Empirical formula calculation Example 8.1: The compound formed between sodium and sulfur
1.15g of sodium reacted with 0.8g of sulphur. Calculate the empirical formula of sodium sulphide.
You convert the masses to moles i.e. mass in g divided by the relative atomic mass.
Since one mole of any defined substance contains the same number of particles (e.g. atoms), it means that the atomic mole
ratio is also the actual ratio of atoms in the compound.
The ratio is then expressed as the simplest whole ratio from which the empirical formula is derived.
Apart from a 1, other numbers e.g. 2, 3 etc. should be seen as subscripts in the empirical formula.
RATIOS ...
masses
1.15g
0.80g
0.05 / 0.025 = 2
0.025 / 0.025 = 1
or 0.05 x 40 = 2
or 0.025 x 40 = 1
therefore the simplest integer ratio = 2 : 1, so empirical formula for sodium sulphide = Na2S
Empirical formula calculation Example 8.2 The empirical formula of aluminium oxide
1.35g of aluminium was heated in oxygen until there was no further gain in weight. The white oxide ash formed weighed
2.55g. Deduce the empirical formula of aluminium oxide. Note: to get the mass of oxygen reacting, all you have to do is to
subtract the mass of metal from the mass of the oxide formed.
RATIOS ...
masses
1.35g
0.05 / 0.05 = 1
(then x 2 = 2)
(then x 2 = 3)
or 0.05 x 40 = 2
or 0.075 x 40 = 3
therefore the simplest integer ratio is 2 : 3, so empirical formula for aluminium oxide = Al2O3
masses
1.448g
0.0259 / 0.0259 = 1
(then x 3 = 3)
(then x 3 = 4.008)
~4
therefore the simplest integer ratio = 3 : 4, so empirical formula for the iron oxide = Fe3O4
Empirical formula and molecular formula calculation Example 8.4 for a hydrocarbon compound
On analysis a hydrocarbon was found to consist of 81.8% carbon and 18.2% hydrogen.
Molecular ion measurements in a mass spectrometer show that the hydrocarbon has a molecular mass of 44.
Treat the percentages as if they were masses in grams, and it all works out fine.
RATIOS ...
masses
81.8
18.2
81.8 / 12 = 6.817
18.2 / 1 = 18.2
6.817/6.817 = 1.0
18.2/6.817 = 2.67
1.0 x 2 = 2
2.670 x 2 = 5.34
1.0 x 3 = 3.0
therefore the simplest integer ratio = 3 : 8, so empirical formula for the hydrocarbon = C3H8
The empirical formula mass = (3 x 12) + 8 = 44
This equals the molecular mass, therefore the molecular formula is also C3H8
Empirical formula and molecular formula calculation Example 8.5 for another hydrocarbon compound
On analysis a hydrocarbon was found to consist of 83.72% carbon and 16.28% hydrogen.
Molecular ion measurements in a mass spectrometer show that the hydrocarbon has a molecular mass of 86.
Again, treat the percentages as if they were masses in grams, and it all works out fine.
RATIOS ...
masses
83.72
16.28
83.72 / 12 = 6.977
16.28 / 1 = 16.28
6.977/6.977 = 1.0
16.28/6.977 = 2.333
1.0 x 2 = 2.0
2.333 x 2 = 4.667
1.0 x 3 = 3.0
2.333 x 3 = 7.00
therefore the simplest integer ratio = 3 : 7, so empirical formula for the hydrocarbon = C3H7
The empirical formula mass = (3 x 12) + 7 = 43
BUT the molecular mass is double this, so the molecular formula must be double the empirical formula
Therefore the molecular formula is C6H14 of which there are many structural isomers!
Empirical formula and molecular formula calculation Example 8.6 for a carbohydrate sugar compound
A carbohydrate compound e.g. a sugar, was found on analysis to contain 40.00% carbon, 6.67% hydrogen and 53.33%
oxygen.
The molecular mass was 150. From the information calculate the empirical formula and deduce the molecular formula.
RATIOS ...
masses
40.00
6.67
53.33
6.67/3.333 ~2.0
3.333/3.333 = 1.0
therefore the simplest integer ratio = 1 : 2 : 1, so empirical formula for the sugar = CH2O
The empirical formula mass = 12 + 2 + 16 = 30
BUT the molecular mass is 5 x this (150/30), so the molecular formula must be 5 x the empirical formula
Therefore the molecular formula is C5H10O , a pentose, of which there are many structural isomers!
Empirical formula and molecular formula calculation Example 8.7 for a chloroalkane compound
A chlorinated hydrocarbon compound when analysed, consisted of 24.24% carbon, 4.04% hydrogen, 71.72% chlorine.
The molecular mass was found to be 99 from another experiment.
Deduce the empirical and molecular formula.
You can 'treat' the %'s as if they were grams, and it all works out like examples 1 and 2, i.e. based on a total mass of 100g.
RATIOS ...
Hydrogen (Ar = 1)
Reacting mass or %
mass
24.24
4.04
71.72
4.04 / 2.02 = 2
2.02 / 2.02 = 1
therefore the simplest atomic ratio = 1 : 2 : 1, so empirical formula for the chlorinated hydrocarbon = CH2Cl
BUT the molecular mass is 99, and the empirical formula mass is 49.5 (12+2+35.5)
AND 99 / 49.5 = 2, and so the molecular formula must be 2 x CH2Cl = C2H4Cl2
two possible structures, which cannot be distinguished by the data or calculation above
1,2-dichloroethane and 1,1-dichloroethane
9. The molar gas volume in calculations, moles, gas volumes and Avogadro's Law
Avogadro's Law states that equal volumes of gases under the same conditions of temperature and pressure
contain the same number of molecules.
o So the volumes have equal moles of separate particles in them.
o One mole of any gas (or the formula mass in g), at the same temperature and pressure occupies the same
volume .
3
3
o
o This is 24dm (24 litres) or 24000 cm , at room temperature of 25 C/298K and normal pressure of 101.3 kPa
or 1 atmosphere (both = RTP).
3
o
o The molar volume for s.t.p is 22.4 dm (22.4 litres) at 0 C and 1atmosphere pressure.
o
o Historically, s.t.p unfortunately stands for standard temperature and pressure, but these days 25 C/298K is
usually considered the standard temperature (RTP).
Some handy relationships for substance Z below:
moles Z = mass of Z gas (g) / atomic or formula mass of gas Z (g/mol)
o mass of Z in g = moles of Z x atomic or formula mass of Z
o atomic or formula mass of Z = mass of Z / moles of Z
o 1 mole = formula mass of Z in g.
gas volume of Z = moles of Z x volume of 1 mole
o rearranging this equation gives ...
o moles of Z = gas volume of Z / volume of 1 mole
o The latter form of the equation can be used to calculate molecular mass from experimental data because
moles = mass / molecular mass
molecular mass = mass / moles
so, if you know the mass of a gas and its volume, you can work out moles of gas and then work out
molecular mass.
This has been done experimentally in the past, but these days, molecular mass is readily done very
accurately in a mass spectrometer.
o
Note (i): In the following examples, assume you are dealing with room temperature and pressure i.e. 25 C and 1
atmosphere pressure.
Note (ii):
o Apart from solving the problems using the mole concept (method (a) below, and reading any equations
involved in a 'molar way' ...
o It is also possible to solve them without using the mole concept (method (b) below). You still use the molar
volume itself, but you think of it as the volume occupied by the formula mass of the gas in g and never think
about moles!
Molar gas volume calculation Example 9.1
o What is the volume of 3.5g of hydrogen? [Ar(H) = 1]
o common thinking: hydrogen exists as H2 molecules, so Mr(H2) = 2, so 1 mole or formula
mass in g = 2g
o method (a)
so moles of hydrogen = 3.5/2 = 1.75 mol H2
3
3
so volume H2 = mol H2 x molar volume = 1.75 x 24 = 42 dm (or 42000 cm )
o method (b):
3
2g occupies 24 dm , so scaling up for the volume of hydrogen ...
3
3
3.5 g will have a volume of 3.5/2 x 24 = 42 dm (or 42000 cm )
Molar gas volume calculation Example 9.2
o Given the equation
o MgCO3(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> MgSO4(aq) + H2O(l) +CO2(g)
3
o What mass of magnesium carbonate is needed to make 6 dm of carbon dioxide? [Ar's: Mg = 24, C =
12, O = 16, H =1 and S = 32]
o method (a):
3
3
since 1 mole = 24 dm , 6 dm is equal to 6/24 = 0.25 mol of gas
3
From the equation, 1 mole of MgCO3 produces 1 mole of CO2, which occupies a volume of 24 dm .
so 0.25 moles of MgCO3 is need to make 0.25 mol of CO2
formula mass of MgCO3 = 24 + 12 + 3x16 = 84,
so required mass of MgCO3 = mol x formula mass = 0.25 x 84 = 21g
o method (b):
converting the equation into the required reacting masses ..
formula masses: MgCO3 = 84 (from above), CO2 = 12 + 2x16 = 44
MgCO3 : CO2 equation ratio is 1 : 1
so 84g of MgCO3 will form 44g of CO2
3
44g of CO2 will occupy 24dm
3
so scaling down, 6 dm of CO2 will have a mass of 44 x 8/24 = 11g
SECTION 10. REACTING GAS VOLUME RATIOS, AVOGADRO'S LAW AND GAY-LUSSAC'S LAW
10. Reacting gas volume ratios of reactants or products (Avogadro's Law, Gay-Lussac's Law)
In the diagram above, if the volume on the left syringe is twice that of the gas volume in the right, then there are twice as
many moles or actual molecules in the left-hand gas syringe.
Revise section 7. moles and mass before proceeding in this section 11 and eventually you may need to be
familiar with the use of the apparatus illustrated above, some of which gives great accuracy when dealing
with solutions and some do not.
It is very useful to be know exactly how much of a dissolved substance is present in a
solution of particular concentration or volume of a solution.
o So we need a standard way of comparing the concentrations of solutions in.
o The more you dissolve in a given volume of solvent, or the smaller the volume you
dissolve a given amount of solute in, the more concentrated the solution.
The concentration of an aqueous solution is usually expressed in terms of moles of
dissolved substance per cubic decimetre (reminder mole formula triangle on the right),
-3
3
with units mol dm (or mol/dm )and this is called molarity, sometimes denoted in shorthand
as M.
3
3
3
3
o Note: 1dm = 1 litre = 1000ml = 1000 cm , so dividing cm /1000 gives dm , which
3
is handy to know since most volumetric laboratory apparatus is calibrated in cm (or ml), but solution
3
concentrations are usually quoted in molarity, that is mol/dm (mol/litre).
3
o Concentration is also expressed in a 'non-molar' format of mass per volume e.g. g/dm
Equal volumes of solution of the same molar concentration contain the same number of moles of solute i.e.
the same number of particles as given by the chemical formula.
You need to be able to calculate
o the number of moles or mass of substance in an aqueous solution of given volume and concentration
o the concentration of an aqueous solution given the amount of substance and volume of water, for this you
use the equation .... (reminder molarity formula triangle on the right),
3
o (1a) molarity (concentration) of Z = moles of Z / volume in dm
you need to be able to rearrange this equation ... therefore ...
3
(1b) moles = molarity (concentration) x volume in dm and ...
3
(1c) volume in dm = moles / molarity (concentration)
o You may also need to know that ...
3
(2) molarity x formula mass of solute = solute concentration in g/dm
3
and dividing this by 1000 gives the concentration in g/cm , and
3
3
(3) concentration in g/dm / formula mass = molarity in mol/dm
both equations (2) and (3) result from equations (1) and (4), work it out for yourself.
and don't forget by now you should know:
(4) moles Z = mass Z / formula mass of Z
(5) 1 mole = formula mass in grams
SECTION 14. % ACTUAL AND THEORETICAL YIELD, DILUTION CALCULATIONS, ATOM ECONOMY,
VOLUMETRIC TITRATION APPARATUS, WATER OF CRYSTALLISATION, HOW MUCH REACTANT IS
NEEDED?
Purity is very important e.g. for analytical standards in laboratories or pharmaceutical products where impurities
could have dangerous side effects in a drug or medicine. However in any chemical process it is almost impossible to
get 100.00% purity and so samples are always analysed in industry to monitor the quality of the product.
% purity is the percentage of the material which is the actually desired chemical in a sample of it.
MASS of USEFUL PRODUCT
PERCENT PURITY = 100 x
Example 14.1.1
o A 12.00g sample of a crystallised pharmaceutical product was found to contain 11.57g of the active drug.
o Calculate the % purity of the sample of the drug.
o % purity = actual amount of desired material x 100 / total amount of material
o % purity = 11.57 x 100 / 12 = 96.4% (to 1dp)
o Example 14.1.2
o Sodium chloride was prepared by neutralising sodium hydroxide solution with dilute hydrochloric acid. The
solution was evaporated to crystallise the salt.
o The salt is required to be completely anhydrous, that is, not containing any water.
o
o The prepared salt was analysed for water by heating a sample in an oven at 110 C to measure the
evaporation of any residual water.
o The following results were obtained and from them calculate the % purity of the salt.
o Mass of evaporating dish empty = 51.32g.
o Mass of impure salt + dish = 56.47g
o Mass of dish + salt after heating = 56.15g
o Therefore the mass of original salt = 56.47 - 51.32 = 5.15g
o and the mass of pure salt remaining = 56.15 - 51.32 = 4.83g
o % salt purity = 4.83 x 100 / 5.15 = 93.8% (to 1dp)
The % yield of a reaction is the percentage of the product obtained compared to the theoretical maximum
(predicted) yield calculated from the balanced equation.
o You get the predicted maximum yield from a reacting mass calculation (see examples further down).
ACTUAL YIELD (e.g. in grams)
PERCENTAGE YIELD =
In carrying out a chemical preparation, the aim is to work carefully and recover as much of the desired reaction
product as you can, and as pure as is possible and practicable.
o Despite the law of conservation of mass, i.e. no atoms lost or gained, in real chemical preparations things
cannot work out completely according to chemical theory, often for quite simple, physical or sometimes
chemical reasons,
o and it doesn't matter with its a small scale school laboratory preparation of a large scale industrial
manufacturing process, the percent yield is never 100%.
So, in any chemical process, it is almost impossible to get 100% of the product because of several reasons:
1.
The reaction might not be 100% completed because it is reversible reaction and an equilibrium is established
(note the
sign in the equation below. Both reactants and products co-exist in the same reaction mixtures (solutions or
gases) i.e. the reaction can never go to completion.
A good example of this is the preparation of an ester
ethanoic acid + ethanol
ethyl ethanoate + water
+
+ H2O
2.
You always get losses of the desired product as it is separated from the reaction mixture by filtration, distillation,
crystallisation or whatever method is required.
e.g. bits of solid or droplets are left behind on the sides of the apparatus or reactor vessel.
Small amounts of liquid will be left in distillation units or solid particles on the surface of filtration
units.
You cannot avoid losing traces of product in all stages of the manufacturing process.
3.
Some of the reactants may react in another way to give a different product to the one you want (so-called by
products).
By products are very common in organic chemistry reactions
(i) A + B ==> C + D
(i) The main reaction to give the main desired products A + B
(ii) A + B ==> E + F
(ii) A con-current reaction, maybe just involving a few % of the reactants to give the minor,
and often undesirable, by products of E + F.
Sometimes the by products can be separated as a useful product and sold to help the
economics of the chemical process.
4.
The aim is to work carefully and recover as much of the desired reaction product, and as pure as is possible and
practicable
% yield = actual amount of desired chemical obtained x 100 / maximum theoretical amount formed
o If the reaction doesn't work the yield is zero or 0%.
o If the reaction works perfectly and you obtain all the product, the yield is 100%, BUT this never happens in
reality (as already discussed above).
Example 14.2a.1
o Magnesium metal dissolves in hydrochloric acid to form magnesium chloride.
o Mg(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MgCl2(aq) + H2(g)
o Atomic masses : Mg = 24 and Cl = 35.5, and formula mass MgCl2 = 24 + (2 x 35.5) = 95
o (a) What is the maximum theoretical mass of anhydrous magnesium chloride which can be made from 12g
of magnesium?
Reacting mass ratio calculation from the balanced equation:
1 Mg ==> 1 MgCl2, so 24g ==> 95g or 12g ==> 47.5g MgCl2
o (b) If only 47.0g of purified magnesium chloride was obtained after crystallising the salt from the solution and
heating it to drive off the water of crystallisation, what is the % yield from the salt preparation?
% yield = actual amount obtained x 100 / maximum theoretical amount possible
% yield = 47.0 x 100 / 47.5 = 98.9% (to 1dp)
o More examples of % yield and atom economy calculations in section 6.
o Example 14.2a.2
o 2.8g of iron was heated with excess sulphur to form iron sulphide.
o Fe + S ==> FeS
o The excess sulphur was dissolved in a solvent and the iron sulphide filtered off, washed with clean solvent
and dried.
o If 4.1g of purified iron sulphide was finally obtained, what was the % yield of the reaction?
o 1st a reacting mass calculation of the maximum amount of FeS that can be formed:
Relative atomic/formula masses: Fe =56, FeS = 56 + 32 = 88
This means 56g Fe ==> 88g FeS, or by ratio, 2.8g Fe ==> 4.4g FeS
because 2.8 is 1/20th of 56, so theoretically you can get 1/20th of 88g of FeS.
o 2nd the % yield calculation itself.
% yield = actual amount obtained x 100 / maximum theoretical amount possible
% yield = 4.1 x 100 / 4.4 = 93.2% (to 1dp)
o More examples of % yield and atom economy calculations in section 6.
o Example 14.2a.3
o (a) Theoretically how much iron can be obtained from 1000 tonne of pure haematite ore, formula
Fe2O3 in a blast furnace?
o If we assume the iron(III) oxide ore (haematite) is reduced by carbon monoxide, the equation is:
o Fe2O3(s) + 3CO(g) ==> 2Fe(l) + 3CO2(g)
o (atomic masses: Fe = 56, O = 16)
o For every Fe2O3 ==> 2Fe can be extracted, formula mass of ore = (2 x 56) + (3 x 56) = 160
o Therefore reacting mass ratio is: 160 ==> 112 (from 2 x 56)
o
o
so, solving the ratio, 1000 ==> 112 / 160 = 700 tonne copper = max. can be extracted
(b) If in reality, only 670 tonne of iron is produced what is the % yield of the overall blast furnace
process?
o % yield = actual yield x 100 / theoretical yield
o % yield = 670 x 100 / 700 = 95.7%
o In other words, 4.3% of the iron is lost in waste e.g. in the slag.
o More examples of % yield and atom economy calculations in section 6.
o Example 14.2a.4
o Given the atomic masses: Mg = 24 and O = 16,
o and the reaction between magnesium to form magnesium oxide is given by the symbol equation
o 2Mg(s) + O2(g) ==> 2MgO(s)
o (a) What mass of magnesium oxide can be made from 1g of magnesium?
2Mg ==> 2MgO
in terms of reacting masses (2 x 24) ==> {2 x (24 +16)}
so 48g Mg ==> 80g MgO (or 24g ==> 40g, its all the same)
therefore solving the ratio
1g Mg ==> w g MgO, using the ratio 48 : 80
w = 1 x 80 / 48 = 1.67g MgO
o (b) Suppose the % yield in the reaction is 80%. That is only 80% of the magnesium oxide formed is actually
recovered as useful product. How much magnesium needs to be burned to make 30g of magnesium
oxide?
This is a bit tricky and needs to done in two stages and can be set out in several ways.
Now 48g Mg ==> 80g MgO (or any ratio mentioned above)
so y g Mg ==> 30g MgO
y = 30 x 48 / 80 = 18g Mg
BUT you only get back 80% of the MgO formed,
so therefore you need to take more of the magnesium than theoretically calculated above.
Therefore for practical purposes you need to take, NOT 18g Mg, BUT ...
... since you only get 80/100 ths of the product ...
... you need to use 100/80 ths of the reactants in the first place
therefore Mg needed = 18g x 100 / 80 = 22.5g Mg
CHECK: reacting mass calculation + % yield calculation CHECK:
22.5 Mg ==> z MgO, z = 22.5 x 80 / 48 = 37.5g MgO,
but you only get 80% of this,
so you actually get 37.5 x 80 / 100 = 30g
This means in principle that if you only get x% yield ...
... you need to take 100/x quantities of reactants to compensate for the losses.
-2
-2
Example 14.3.4
-3
o You are given a stock solution of concentrated ammonia with a concentration of 17.9 mol dm (conc.
ammonia! ~18M!)
3
o (a) What volume of the conc. ammonia is needed to make up 1dm of 1.0 molar ammonia solution?
Method (i) using simple ratio argument.
The conc. ammonia must be diluted by a factor of 1.0/17.9 to give a 1.0 molar solution.
3
3
Therefore you need (1.0/17.9) x 1000 cm = 55.9 cm of the conc. ammonia.
3
3
3
-3
If the 55.9 cm of conc. ammonia is diluted to 1000 cm (1 dm ) you will have a 1.0 mol dm (1M)
solution.
Method (ii) using molar concentration equation - a much better method that suits any kind of
dilution calculation involving molarity.
3
3
molarity = mol / volume (dm ), therefore mol = molarity x volume in dm
3
Therefore you need 1.0 x 1.0 = 1.0 moles of ammonia to make 1 dm of 1.0M dilute
ammonia.
Volume = mol / molarity
3
3
Volume of conc. ammonia needed = 1.0 / 17.9 = 0.0559 dm (55.9 cm ) of the conc.
ammonia is required,
3
-3
and, if this is diluted to 1 dm , it will give you a 1.0 mol dm dilute ammonia solution.
3
o (b) What volume of conc. ammonia is needed to make 5 dm of a 1.5 molar solution?
3
3
molarity = mol / volume (dm ), therefore mol = molarity x volume in dm
3
Therefore you need 1.5 x 5 = 7.5 moles of ammonia to make 5 dm of 1.5M dilute ammonia.
Volume (of conc. ammonia needed) = mol / molarity
3
3
Volume of conc. ammonia needed = 7.5 / 17.9 = 0.419 dm (419 cm ) of the conc. ammonia is
required,
3
-3
and, if this is diluted to 5 dm , it will give you a 1.5 mol dm dilute ammonia solution.
Example 14.4.1: Calculate the % of water in hydrated magnesium sulphate MgSO 4.7H2O salt crystals
o Relative atomic masses: Mg = 24, S = 32, O = 16 and H = 1
o relative formula mass = 24 + 32 + (4 x 16) + [7 x (1 + 1 + 16)] = 246
o 7 x 18 = 126 is the mass of water
o so % water = 126 x 100 / 246 = 51.2%
Example 14.4.2 The % water of crystallisation and the formula of the salt are calculated as follows:
o Suppose 6.25g of blue hydrated copper(II) sulphate, CuSO4.xH2O, (x unknown) was gently heated in a
crucible until the mass remaining was 4.00g. This is the white anhydrous copper(II) sulphate.
o The mass of anhydrous salt = 4.00g, mass of water (of crystallisation) driven off = 6.25-4.00 = 2.25g
o The % water of crystallisation in the crystals is 2.25 x 100 / 6.25 = 36%
o [ Ar's Cu=64, S=32, O=16, H=1 ]
o The mass ratio of CuSO4 : H2O is 4.00 : 2.25
o To convert from mass ratio to mole ratio, you divide by the molecular mass of each 'species'
o CuSO4 = 64 + 32 + (4x18) = 160 and H2O = 1+1+16 = 18
o The mole ratio of CuSO4 : H2O is 4.00/160 : 2.25/18
o which is 0.025 : 0.125 or 1 : 5, so the formula of the hydrated salt is CuSO4.5H2O
Example 14.4.3 How to calculate the theoretical % of water in a hydrated salt
o eg magnesium sulphate MgSO4.7H2O salt crystals
Example 1. How much iron and sulfur do you need to heat together to make 20.0 g of iron sulfide
o Atomic masses: Fe = 56 and S = 32
o Balanced equation: Fe + S ==> FeS
o
This is essentially a reacting mass calculation
Pick out the particular ratio you need to solve the
reacting mass problem e.g. the particular reactant
and product
comments
Fe + S
==>
FeS
56g + 32g
==>
88g
56/88 = 0.6364g
+ 32/88 = 0.3636
==>
88g/88 = 1.00g
20 x 0.6364 =
12.7g + 20 x
0.3636 = 7.3g
20 x 100 = 20.0g
==>
Therefore to make 20g of iron sulfide you need 12.7g of iron and 7.3g of sulfur.
o Example 2. How much iron do you need to make 100.00g of iron(III) chloride by passing excess chlorine gas
over heated iron filings?
o Atomic masses: Fe = 56 and Cl = 35.5, formula mass of FeCl3 = 162.5 (56 + 3x35.5)
o Balanced equation: 2Fe(s) + 3Cl2(g) ==> 2FeCl3(s)
o
This is essentially a reacting mass calculation
Pick out the particular ratio you need to solve the
reacting mass problem e.g. the particular reactant
and product
2Fe
==>
comments
2FeCl3
2 x 56 = 112g
==>
2 x 162.5 = 325g
112/325 =
0.3446g
==>
325/325 = 1.00g
100 x 0.3446 =
34.46g
==>
100 x 1 = 100.00g
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
ENERGETICS
ADVANCED LEVEL ENERGETICSTHERMOCHEMISTRY ENTHALPIES OF REACTION, FORMATION &
COMBUSTION
1.1a I have ASSUMED you have studied the GCSE notes on the basics of chemical energy changes
in what you might call a lower level introduction which bridges GCSE and AS level and you are completely ok in
interpreting enthalpy level and activation energy diagrams such as ...
... and can clearly distinguish between enthalpy change and activation energy and the activation energy change
with a catalyst does NOT change the enthalpy value of the reaction (activation energy will be rarely mentioned until
the end of Part 3), but all important ideas from the GCSE page will be re-studied in their advanced level context, but
I would still study the GCSE page first!
REMEMBER - all chemical changes are accompanied by energy changes or energy transfers, many of which can be
directly measured, or, theoretically calculated from known values.
-1
i.e. the figure of 890 kJ released refers to the complete combustion of 1 mole of gaseous methane (24 dm ), using exactly 2
3
3
moles of gaseous oxygen (48 dm ) to form exactly 1 mole of gaseous carbon dioxide (24 dm ) and 2 moles of liquid water.
o
These values refer to 298K (25 C and 1 atm/101 kPa)
Note some general points (which apply to all exothermic or endothermic changes, physical or chemical changes):
(i) All enthalpy values must be quoted with referenced to the ambient/assumed temperature and pressure of the system
undergoing the physical or chemical change.
o
The usual standard reference conditions are 298K (25 C and 1 atm/101 kPa), and other criteria may apply e.g. 1 molar
solution if applicable.
(ii) Not only the molar quantities must clearly indicated BUT the physical states of all the substances must be clearly stated
too.
This is a convenient point to make the point about the importance of state symbols via the combustion of hydrogen. eg
1
-1
-1
If the water forms remains as steam/vapour/gas, then 44.1 kJ less heat energy is released to the surroundings, because
condensation is an exothermic process (g ==> l) and forming liquid water releases an extra 44.1 kJ. The -285.9 (~-286) kJ
-1
mol is the usual value for the enthalpy of combustion of hydrogen you will encounter in your studies because at the
standard temperature of 298K water is a liquid in its normal stable state.
(iii) This sort of combustion reaction can be measured in a calorimeter (see section 1.3). BUT, however the enthalpy
change is measured, all equations should be read in molar terms when dealing with enthalpy values i.e. a delta H value
goes with a specific equation.
-1
(iv) Enthalpy change values are usually quoted in kJ mol , but take care in their interpretation because you must know
what equation goes with the H value!
eg the enthalpy of combustion usually refers to the complete combustion of one mole of the combustible material as for
water above, BUT if you double the equation you must also double the enthalpy values for that equation
-1
Endothermic reaction
A reaction in which the system takes in or absorbs heat energy from the surroundings i.e. the enthalpy of the system
increases and the temperature of the system and surroundings falls OR the system must be heated to initiate the reaction
and provide the heat absorbed.
This means Hproducts > Hreactants so that H is positive (+ve).
The enthalpy of the reaction system is increasing.
Example: The thermal decomposition of calcium carbonate
CaCO3(s) ==> CaO(s) + CO2(g) H = +179 kJmol
-1
i.e. 179 kJ of heat energy must be absorbed to decompose 1 mole of solid calcium carbonate into 1 mole of solid calcium
oxide and 1 mole of gaseous carbon dioxide. Mr(CaCO3) = 100, so 17.9 kJ of heat energy is absorbed in decomposing 10g
o
of limestone. This reaction requires an experimental temperature of 800-1000 C to achieve an appreciable rate of reaction
and cannot be studied quantitatively in the laboratory. However it can be theoretically calculated from known enthalpy
change values by means of a Hess's Law cycle calculation.
The two diagrams below illustrate how exothermic (left) and endothermic (right) reactions are specified on an enthalpy level
diagram.
Standard conditions
Standard conditions for referencing enthalpy values are essential for communicating accurate data throughout the
scientific community.
It means values measured/calculated in one laboratory/research team can be used in another scientific establishment
anywhere!, OR checked for accuracy by any other scientists.
In this way accurate enthalpy data can be built up and through time validated and perhaps more accurately measured with
technological developments and theoretical calculations become more reliable.
This means the reactants/products start/finish at a specified temperature, pressure and concentration whatever the
'temporary' temperature change in the reaction - which is required to calculate the enthalpy change.
The net energy change is based on the products returning to the same temperature and pressure that the reactants started
o
o
at. The most frequently used standard conditions are a temperature of 298 K/25 C (K = 273 + C) and a pressure of 1
-3
atm/101 kPa and a concentration of 1.00 mol dm .
The use of standard conditions enables a database of delta H change to be assembled from which you can do theoretical
calculations (see section 1.2 using Hess's Law).
Strictly speaking the standard conditions should be indicated in terms of the standard temperature and the reactants
involved and standard delta H values are denoted with the Greek letter theta ().
By using data based on standard. agreed and defined conditions, then the data can be used universally by any
laboratory around the world and also allows scientists to check each others experimental results.
Its pertinent here to consider the question - how can you have an standard enthalpy of combustion at 25 C when the
o
flame temperature is perhaps peaking at over 1000 C !!!
The answer applies to all enthalpy changes what-so-ever!
The enthalpy change represents the heat energy change needed to restore the products to the temperature of the reactants
o
at the start e.g. room temperature/25 C.
Standard Enthalpy of Reaction Hr/react/reaction is the enthalpy change (heat absorbed/released, endothermic/exothermic)
o
when molar quantities of reactants as stated in an equation react under standard conditions (i.e. 298K/25 C, 1 atm/101kPa)
Examples
(i) NaOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> NaCl(aq) + H2O(aq) (exothermic)
H
r,298
-1
r,298
-1
Standard Enthalpy of Formation Hf/form/formation is the enthalpy change when 1 mole of compound is formed from its
o
constituent elements with both the compound and elements in their standard states ('normal stable states) i.e. at 298K/25 C,
1 atm/101kPa
(a) It may be endothermic or exothermic
(b) Any accompanying equation should involve the formation of 1 mole of the compound
o
The standard state is the most stable state at the standard temperature and pressure e.g. at 298K/25 C and 1 atm/101kPa
e.g. H2(g) H2O(l) C(s) O2(g), C3H8(g) C8H18(l) C24H50(s) CO2(g) CH3CH2OH(l) etc.
Examples
(i) C(s) + 2H2(g) ==> CH4(g) H
f,298(methane)
f,298(ethene)
= -74.9 kJ mol
= +52.3 kJ mol
-1
f,298(nitrogen
-1
f,298(ethanol)
= -278 kJ mol
-1
-1
c,298K(propane)
= -2219 kJ mol
c,298K(ethanoic
-1
-1
In the calculations explained below just the subscripted letters r/f/c will be used for brevity and a temperature of 298K and a
constant pressure 1atm assumed unless otherwise stated. There is more the enthalpies of combustion of alkanes and
alcohols in section 1.4a
Standard enthalpy of neutralisation is the energy released when unit molar quantities of acids and alkalis completely
neutralise each other at 298K (pressure effects are insignificant for reactions only involving liquids/solutions/solids)
(i) NaOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> NaCl(aq) + H2O(l) H
neutralisation
= -57.1 kJ mol
neutralisation
-1
= -116.4 kJ mol
neutralisation
-1
= -58.2 kJ mol
-1
Note! It looks as if the enthalpy of neutralisation of barium hydroxide is approximately double that of sodium hydroxide ie ~
twice as exothermic! Well yes it is! and no it isn't!
Yes - ~twice as much energy is released per mole of soluble base/alkali.
No - however, on the basis of heat released per mole of water formed, they are actually very similar.
In other words, which value you quote, depends on which point you want to make.
Yet another example of carefully qualifying enthalpy values with respect to the context.
More on enthalpies of neutralisation
Bond Enthalpy ('bond energy')
This is the average energy absorbed to break 1 mole of a specified bond when all species involved are in the
gaseous state.
e.g. for (i) H2(g) ==> 2H(g) H = +436 kJ mol
-1
-1
It is always endothermic and the reverse process - bond formation, is always exothermic. In many cases the values are
averaged from a variety of 'molecular' situations. More on this in the bond enthalpy section.
Some examples of points made on this page with reference to an enthalpy level change diagram
General points: Arrows pointing downwards represent exothermic changes and arrows pointing upwards represent
endothermic changes
1. The energy released when 1 mole of aluminium oxide is formed.
-1
The H value of -1669 kJ mol corresponds to the very exothermic enthalpy of formation of Al2O3 or the enthalpy of the
complete combustion of two moles of Al.
The very exothermicity of the reaction suggests, and correctly, that aluminium oxide is a very stable compound - it is
o
thermally stable to at least 2500 C.
2. The endothermic enthalpy of formation of gold(III) oxide
o
It is a compound not readily formed and it decomposes on heating at ~150 C, so contrast this thermal instability with that of
aluminium oxide.
3. This is a much more complex enthalpy level diagram involving hydrogen, chlorine and hydrogen chloride.
-1
The +436 kJmol represents the bond enthalpy for splitting hydrogen molecules into hydrogen atoms.
-1
The very exothermic -862 kJmol is the energy released theoretically when two moles of hydrogen chloride are formed
directly from hydrogen and chlorine atoms.
The latter indicates that the H-Cl bond enthalpy is +862/2 = 431 kJmol
-1
END OF ENERGETICS
1. A few snippets of the past and continuing history of the Periodic Table
Not all scientists are mentioned who perhaps should be, but I've tried to pick out a few 'highlight' and added some
footnotes on what was happening in terms of the development of the detailed knowledge of the structure of atoms,
so essential to the modern interpretation of the Periodic Table. Its a good 'advanced' example of how science works
i.e. the relationship between experimental data and theories to account for it, questions posed, questions answered,
leading to more comprehensive and accurate theories developing.
1.1 The early classification of Antoine Lavoisier of 1789
Antoine Lavoisier's 1789 classification of substances into four 'element' groups
acid-making elements
gas-like elements
metallic elements
earthy elements
sulphur
light
phosphorus
caloric (heat)
charcoal (carbon)
oxygen
azote (nitrogen)
manganese, tungsten
hydrogen
platina (platinum)
The understanding that an element as a unique atomic 'building block' which could not be split into simpler
substances and compound is a chemical combination of two or more elements were not at all understood at the time
of Lavoisier.
'light' and 'caloric' (heat), were considered 'substances' and the last 'scientific' vestige of the elements of 'earth, fire,
air and water' which had there conceptual origin in the Greek civilisation of 2300-2800 years ago.
However, Lavoisier was correct on a few things e.g. the elements sulphur, phosphorus and carbon and correctly
described their oxides as acidic e.g. dissolved in water turned litmus turns red.
Many metallic elements, were correctly identified though I doubt if they were pure though!
What he described as the 'earthy elements' are of course compounds, a chemical combination of a metal plus
oxygen or sulfur (both O and S in case of barium).
He didn't have very high temperature smelting technology, or a reactive metal from electrolysis (came in about 1806
onwards)' to 'separate' the elements in some way e.g. he couldn't extract a reactive metal! In other words, at this
time, the wrong 'classification' was due to a lack of chemical technology as much as lack of knowledge.
o Atomic structure history note: You can see from the 1789 'table' Lavoisier and his contemporaries did not
have the experiment techniques, data or theoretical framework to clearly distinguish between 'elements' and
'compounds'. It was only in 1808 Dalton proposed his atomic theory based on experimental data and
produced the first list of 'atomic weights', which we now call relative atomic masses.
Johann Dbereiner noted that certain elements seemed to occur as 'triads' of similar elements e.g.
o (i) lithium, sodium and potassium
o (ii) calcium, strontium and barium
o (iii) chlorine, bromine and iodine
Dbereiner was amongst the first scientists to recognise the 'group' idea of chemically very similar elements.
Three groups he 'recognised' were (i) Group 1 Alkali Metals, (ii) Group 2 Alkaline Earth Metals, (iii) Group 7
Halogens.
o Atomic structure history note: The physical and chemical likeness of the three members of these 'triad
groups' should be evident and it was based purely on observation, however Dbereiner and contemporaries
where unaware of the atomic and molecular nature of these elements e.g. the atomic nature of the metals
(M atoms) and the molecular nature of the Halogens (X 2 diatomic molecules). In fact the concept of a
'molecule' was first realised by Avogadro in 1811 but it took 50 years before the genius of his experimental
work and intuition was fully realised.
Li
Ga
Na
Mg
Al
Si
Cl
Ca
Cr
Ti
Mn
Fe
Co, Ni
Cu
Zn
In
As
Se
Br
Rb
Sr
Ce, La
Zr
Di, Mo
Ro, Ru
Pd
Ag
Cd
Sn
Sb
Te
Cs
Ba, V
Ta
Nb
Au
Pt, Ir
Tl
Pb
Th
Hg
Bi
Cs
Newlands recognised that every 7 elements, the 8th seemed to be very similar to the 1st of the previous 7 when laid
out in a 'periodic' manner and he was one of the first scientists to derive a 'Periodic Table' from the available
knowledge.
e.g. his 'table' consists of almost completely genuine elements (Di was a mix of two elements), classified roughly into
groups of similar elements and a real recognition of 'periodicity'
He also recognised that the 'groups' had more than 3 elements (not just 'triads'), and was correct to mix up metals
and non-metals in same group e.g. in 5th column there is carbon, silicon, tin (Sn) from what we know call Group 4.
However, indium is in group 3 but Ti, Zr have a valency of 4, like Group 4 elements and do form part of vertical
column in what we know call the Transition Metal series
Other correct 'patterns' if not precise are recognisable in terms of the modern Periodic Table e.g. half of column 2
is Group 1, half of column 3 is Group 2, half of column 5 is Group 4, half of column 6 is Group 5, half of column 7 is
Group 6. If we put his column 1 as column 7, it would seem a better match of today!
Although none of his vertical column groups match completely but the basic pattern of the modern periodic
table was emerging. However column's 1 and 7 do seem particularly mixed up compared to the modern periodic
table.
o Atomic structure history note: A good wedge of history at this point!
The Greeks Leucippus and Democritus ~500-400 BC wondered what was the result of continually
dividing a substance i.e. what was the end product or smallest bit i.e. what was left that was
indivisible - the word atom/atomic is from Greek adjective atomos meaning 'not divisible'.
They considered that matter is made of atoms that are too small to be see and cannot be
divided into smaller particles. They speculated that there was empty space between solid
atoms and that atoms were the same throughout a cross section and atoms could have
different sizes, shapes and masses.
These were brilliant ideas for their time and such concepts were the result of excellent
intuitive thinking BUT the famous and much more eminent and revered philosopher
Aristotle, didn't think much of their theory, and so atomic theory never developed for nearly
2000 years!
Its worth commenting further on the Greeks. Although brilliant in intellectual
discourse on many subjects and legendary mathematicians, they were NOT very
good at science. Most Greek intellectuals did not consider doing experiments to test
out theories as very important, and therefore over 2000 years ago they actually
rejected the principal methods by which we today practice science!
However, the Greeks idea of atoms was not completely forgotten and later revived by Boyle and
Newton but with little progress.
Robert Boyle (1627-1691) in his book 'The Sceptical Chemist' talked about tiny identical
particles that were indivisible but could be joined in various ways to make 'compounds'.
But, in 1808, Dalton (1766-1844) proposed his atomic theory that all matter was made up of tiny
hard particles called atoms and the different types of atoms (elements) combined together to give all
the different substances of the physical world.
His theory included the idea that atoms in an element are all the same.
Dalton considered that a compound is made by joining at least two different elements to
form a compound,
and atoms do not change themselves in a reaction but from the original reactants they rearrange to form the products.
This is real progress! Most of his ideas were correct except the 'indivisibility' of the
atom! but it would take nearly another 60 years before the idea of 'atomic structure'
would take shape from experimental results.
He also produced the first list of 'atomic weights' (we now call relative atomic masses) on a
scale based on hydrogen which was given the arbitrary value of 1 since it was lightest
element known, and, as it happens, correctly so.
Dalton also devised symbols for the different elements, but his 'picturesque' symbols were
not universally adopted and today's elements letter symbols were introduced and promoted
by the chemist Jons Berzelius in 1811.
In 1876 Goldstein and Jean Perrin in 1895 (1870-1942) passed a high-voltage electrical discharge
through various gases and discovered beams of negatively charge particles where formed.
They where called cathode rays and, where in fact, what we now know as negative
electrons (but he didn't know this!).
The electrons were emanating from the negative electrode and being accelerated towards
the positive anode.
They were unaware that positive ions were also produced and beamed in the opposite
direction.
Up till then, it was just assumed that matter consisted of Daltons 'atoms' i.e. particles that
could not be broken down into smaller particles, so did not have any meaningful structure
but just combined in various ways to make different compounds.
This was the real start of research into 'atomic structure', especially as it was soon found
later on that a stream of positive particles was travelling in the opposite direction to the
'negative electrons'!
Goldstein's and Perrin's experiments also provided the experimental basis for the
development of the mass spectrograph by Aston - what we know now as a mass
spectrometer.
Mendeleev (Russian chemist) first published his 'Periodic Table' work simultaneously in 1869 with the work of Lothar
Meyer (German chemist) who looked at the physical properties of all known elements.
Lothar Meyer noted 'periodic' trend patterns e.g. peaks and troughs when melting or boiling points, specific heat and
atomic volume values were plotted against 'atomic weight' - what we now call relative atomic mass.
My modern versions of Lothar Meyer's graphs are shown on a separate pages, plus others and now the
properties are plotted against atomic/proton number and I've managed to collect most data upto element 96.
o
o
Elements Z = 1 to 20 covering Periods 1-3 and start of Period 4 Elements Z = 1 to 38 covering Periods
1-4 and start of Period 5 Elements Z = 1 to 96 covering Periods 1-6 and start of Period 7
The atomic volume graph is shown below clearly showing the 'periodic' highest volumes for the alkali metals
- the least dense of the elements in liquid or solid form.
Mendeleev laid out all the known elements in order of 'atomic weight' (what we know call relative atomic mass, Ar)
except for several examples like tellurium (Te, Ar = 127.60) and iodine (I, Ar = 126.90) whose order he reversed
because chemically they seemed to be in the wrong vertical column! Smart thinking!
o Argon (Ar, Ar = 39.95) and potassium (K, Ar = 39.10) is the 2nd example, but that was not a problem for
chemists at the time, because the Group 0 Noble Gases hadn't been discovered by then!
o These 'anomalies' in the order of 'atomic weights' are explained by the existence of isotopes which were
discovered ~1916 and the neutron finally characterised in 1932.
o Isotopes of elements are atoms of the same proton number with different numbers of neutrons, hence atoms
of the same element with different mass numbers.
39
40
o The most abundant stable isotope of potassium is K, and that of argon is Ar, hence the anomaly.
127
120
130
o Naturally occurring iodine is 100% I, but tellurium has a range of isotopic masses from Te to Te but
more the heavier isotopes are more abundant than the lighter isotopes.
By 1869, Mendeleev and Lothar Meyer had an advantage over Newlands (1864) because by then there was an
increased number of known elements and hence 'groups' of similar elements were becoming more clearly defined.
Mendeleev used a double column approach which is NOT incorrect, i.e. a sort of group xA and xB classification. This
is due to the 'insert' of transition metals, some of whom show chemical similarities to the vertical 'groups'. We now
recognise theses dual columns as
His 'presentation' was sufficiently accurate to predict missing elements and their properties * e.g.
germanium (Ge) below silicon (Si) and above tin (Sn) in Group IV and Mendeleev is rightly called
1.5 A modern version Periodic Table based on the electronic structure of atoms
The electronic basis of the periodic table is explained in Part 2.
s block
Pd
1
2
3
Note: (i) H does not readily fit into any group, (ii) He not strictly a 'p' element but does belong in Gp 0/18
4Be
11Na 12Mg
2He
5B
6C
7N
8O
9F
10Ne
13Al
14Si
15P
16S
17Cl
18Ar
19K 20Ca
21Sc
22Ti
37Rb 38Sr
39Y
40Zr
55Cs 56Ba
*57-71
72Hf
87Fr 88Ra
*89-103
23V
31Ga
32Ge
33As
34Se
35Br
36Kr
49In
50Sn
51Sb
52Te
53I
54Xe
73Ta
79Au 80Hg
81Tl
82Pb
83Bi
84Po
85At
86Rn
113?
114Fl
115?
116Lv
117?
118?
*57La
58Ce
59Pr
66Dy
67Ho
68Er
69Tm
70Yb
71Lu
*89Ac
90Th
91Pa
98Cf
99Es
100Fm
101Md
102No
103Lr
74W
75Re 76Os
77Ir
28Ni
78Pt
29Cu
30Zn
Gp 1 Alkali Metals
With increasing knowledge of the elements of the Periodic Table it is now laid out in order of atomic (proton) number.
Due to isotopic masses, the relative atomic mass does go 'up/down' occasionally (there is no obvious 'nuclear' rule
that accounts for this, at least at GCSE/GCE level!). BUT chemically Te is like S and Se etc. and I is like Cl and Br
etc. and so are placed in their correct 'chemically similar family' group and this is now backed up by modern
knowledge of the electron structure of atoms.
We now know the electronic structure of elements and can understand sub-levels and the 'rules' in electron structure
e.g. 2 in shell 1 (period 1, 2 elements H to He), 8 in shell 2 (period 2, 8 elements Li to Ne), there is a sub-level which
allows an extra 10 elements (the transition metals) in period 4 (18 elements, K to Kr). this also explains the sorting
out of Mendeleev's A and B double columns in a group. The periods are complete now that we know about Noble
Gases.
The use and function of the Periodic Table will never cease! Newly 'man-made' elements are being synthesised.
In the 1940's Glenn Seaborg was part of a research team developing the materials required to produce the first
atomic bombs dropped on Hiroshima and Nagasaki. He specialised in separating all the substances made in the first
nuclear reactors and helped discover the series of 'nuclear synthesised' elements beyond the naturally occurring
limit of uranium (92U). From element 93 to 113 are now known, so the structure of the bottom part of the periodic
table will continue to grow. There is plenty of scope for present day, and future Mendeleev's!!!! (will you be one of
em'?).
o Atomic structure history note: From 1913 onwards the electron structure of atoms was gradually being
understood and paralleling the developing knowledge of the structure of the nucleus and its importance in
determining which element an atom was i.e. the atomic/proton number. The Bohr theory of the hydrogen
spectrum (see section 2.6) postulated that the electrons surrounding the positive nucleus could only exist
in specific energy levels and that any electron level change must involve a specific input/output of energy the quanta e.g. a photon of light or X-rays etc.
o In the 1920's and 1930's scientist-mathematicians like Heisenberg and Schrdinger were developing the
mathematical equations known as wave mechanics. These mathematical theories describe the detailed
behaviour of electrons, and out of these equations come the four quantum numbers from which are derived
the set of rules we use to assign electrons in their respective levels (see section 2.2), which ultimately
determines the chemistry of an element.
1.6 Where did elements come from originally? Where do we get the elements from?
Where did elements come from originally? It all starts in the STARS!
The ultimate origin of all elements is the nuclear reactions that go on when stars are formed from inter-stellar dust
and gas forming a huge combined mass due to gravity, and then 'chunks' of a star cool down to form planets. The
heaviest elements are formed in nuclear fusion reactions when stars self-destruct in super-nova explosions.
o The nucleosynthesis of light elements up to Z = 26 (Fe, iron) occurs in stars formed from the condensation
of hydrogen and helium atoms.
o Eventually, as the mass increases, the force of gravity causes such compression that the temperatures rise
considerably at high matter densities and nuclear reactions begin.
o Up to Z = 26 nuclei, they are usually formed energy releasing fusion processes or the decay of unstable
nuclei
o There are hundreds of possible nuclear transformations possible, so, below, I've chosen some examples of
possible nuclear reactions, whose products fit in with the isotopes, mass numbers, relative atomic masses
etc. which A level chemistry students are likely to come across ...
A
o ... in the nuclear equations, for the nuclide symbol ZX, A = mass number, Z = atomic number, X = element
symbol
and gamma photons, and neutrinos, often formed in nuclear changes, are NOT shown for simplicity.
1
1
2
1
o
H
+
1
1H ==> 1H + 0n
7
The formation of hydrogen-2 (deuterium) occurs slowly at a temperature of 1.5 x 10 K e.g. in our
o
Sun (~15 million C).
2
1
3
o
1H + 1H ==> 2He
This is one way the next heaviest element, helium can be formed.
3
3
4
1
o
2He + 2He ==> 2He + 2 1H
From helium-3, the formation of helium-4, the most common isotope of helium we find on earth.
From helium-4, by what is known as the alpha process, a succession of heavier elements can be
synthesised in subsequent nuclear reactions ...
4
8
o 2 2He ==> 4Be
beryllium-8 is very unstable, but is readily converted on collision with another helium-4 nucleus to
give stable carbon-12 (and ultimately life on earth!)
8
4
12
o
4Be + 2He ==>
6C
8
o
These sorts of nuclear reactions need star temperatures of 1 x 10 K (~100 million C)
12
4
16
o
6C + 2He ==>
8O
From carbon-12 you can get oxygen-16, the most common oxygen isotope on earth today.
16
4
20
o
8O + 2He ==>
10Ne
From oxygen-16 you can get neon-20, the most common neon isotope on earth today.
20
4
24
o
10Ne + 2He ==>
12Mg
From neon-20 you can get magnesium-24, the most common magnesium isotope on earth today.
24
4
28
o
10Mg + 2He ==>
14Si
From magnesium-24 you can get silicon-28, the most common silicon isotope on earth today.
28
4
32
o
14Si + 2He ==>
16S
From silicon-28 you can get sulfur-32, the most common sulphur isotope on earth today.
32
4
36
o
16S + 2He ==>
18 Ar
From sulphur-32 you can get argon-36, the most common argon isotope on earth today
36
4
40
o
18 Ar + 2He ==>
20Ca
From argon-36 you can get calcium-40, the most common calcium isotope on earth today.
o
o
You can see from the Periodic Table of relative atomic masses how the alpha-process ('helium burning' has
produced the values for C, O, Ne, Mg, Si, S, Ar and Ca from the principal isotope of multiples of four mass
units.
o There are lots of other possibilities involving H and He nuclei and particularly complicated nuclear fusion
cycle involving carbon nuclei e.g. the six step cycle ...
12
1
13
6C + 1H ==>
7N
13
13
0
7N ==>
cC + +e
13
1
14
6C + 1H ==>
7N
14
1
15
7N + 1H ==>
8O
15
15
0
8O ==>
7N + +e (decay of oxygen-15 by positron emission)
17
1
12
4
7N + 1H ==>
6C + 2He
You can also see how other isotopes of an element can be formed and in the cycle carbon-12 is
reformed to continue these particular nucleosynthesis pathways.
There is a good analogy here with auto-catalytic cycles in chemistry e.g. the removal of ozone by
chlorine atoms.
o The heavier elements beyond iron i.e. Z > 26 Co cobalt onwards must be formed by energy absorbing
processes including neutron capture e.g. the formation of technetium from molybdenum
98
1
99
42Mo + 0n ==>
42Mo
neutron absorbed by molybdenum-98 nucleus to give an unstable Mo nucleus
99
99
0
42Mo ==>
43Tc + -e
Mo-98 nucleus decays by beta particle emission to give an atom of technetium, with a
higher atomic number.
Similarly, gallium can be formed from zinc, i.e. again forming an element of higher atomic number ...
68
1
69
69
69
0
followed by
30Zn + 0n ==>
30Zn
30Zn ==>
31Ga + -e
o So you can see that these nuclear fusion, neutron or proton capture, nuclear decay etc., can over
time, gradually produce all the heavier elements up to element 92 uranium, the last of our naturally
occurring elements.
238
o Even though small amounts of 92U are eventually formed, it requires the highest of temperature
e.g. in a super-nova explosion of giant stars a lot bigger than our sun!
o Some examples of nuclear fusion reactions to form heavier elements are quoted in Part 3.4 Where do
heavier elements come from?
All the elements from atomic numbers 1-92 (H-U) naturally occur on Earth, though some are very unstableradioactive and decay to form more nuclear stable elements.
o Many isotopes of elements after lead, 82Pb are unstable.
o After uranium, 92U, the vast majority of the isotopes of the elements of atomic number 93+ are inherently
unstable.
o They will not have survived even if they were formed billions of years ago in the Sun, and retained or formed
in the initial 'spin-off' material that formed the 'very early' Earth.
o However, the advent of nuclear reactors has enabled up to kg quantities of e.g. plutonium, 94Pu (used in
nuclear reactors and weapons) and americium, 95Am (used in smoke alarms) to be produced.
o Cyclotrons, particle bombardment linear accelerators, have enabled 'super-heavy' elements up to Z = 118?
to be 'synthesised', but only a few atoms at a time (The Russia-US space race seems to have been partly
replaced by 'who can synthesize the biggest atom'!).
o One things for certain, the Periodic Table still keeps growing with newly synthesised elements!
Everything around you is made up of the elements of the periodic table, BUT most are chemically combined with
other elements in the form of many naturally occurring compounds e.g.
o hydrogen and oxygen in water, sodium and chlorine in sodium chloride ('common salt'), iron, oxygen and
carbon as iron carbonate, carbon and oxygen as carbon dioxide etc. etc.!
Therefore, most elements can only be obtained by some kind of chemical process to separate or extract an
element from a compound e.g.
o Less reactive metals are obtained by reduction of their oxides with carbon and more reactive metals are
extracted by electrolysis of their chlorides or oxides (see GCSE/IGCSE/AS notes on Metal Extraction)
o Non-metals are obtained by a variety of means e.g. chlorine is obtained by electrolysis of sodium chloride
solution (see GCSE/IGCSE notes on Group 7 The Halogens).
However some elements never occur as compounds or they occur in their elemental form as well as in
compounds e.g.
o The Group 0 Noble Gases are so unreactive they are only present in the atmosphere as individual atoms.
Since air is a mixture, these gases are separated from air by a physical method of separation by
distillation of liquified air. The elements oxygen and nitrogen are obtained from air at the same time, which is
far more convenient than trying to get them from compounds like oxides and nitrates etc.
o Gold/platinum is are the least reactive metals and are usually found 'native' as the yellow/silver elemental
metal.
o Relatively unreactive metals like copper and silver can also be found in their elemental form in mineral
deposits as well as in metal ores containing compounds like copper carbonate, copper sulphide and silver
sulphide.
o The non-metal sulphur is found combined with oxygen and a metal in compounds known as sulphates, but it
can occur as relatively pure sulphur in yellow mineral beds of the element.
ATOMIC STRUCTURE
th
However from experiments done in the late 19 and early 20 century it was deduced that atoms are made up of three
fundamental or subatomic particles called protons, neutrons and electrons, which are listed below with their relative
masses and electrical charges.
WHAT ARE THE CHARACTERISTIC PROPERTIES OF THESE SUBATOMIC PARTICLES?
Relative mass
Electric charge
Comments
Proton
+1 (+ positive)
Neutron
0 (zero)
1 ( negative)
Electron
/1850 or 0.00055
You can think of the mass of an electron as about /2000th of the mass of a proton or neutron, so, a pretty small mass BUT
they occupy most of the space of atom!!!
What can we say about 'A Portrait of an Atom'? an image of what you can't see!
However this diagram, which is based on the Bohr model of atomic structure, although more realistic in terms of the real size
of the nucleus compared to the atom as a whole, it is not convenient to give a brief diagrammatic picture of the composition
of an atom like the style of the diagram below. The central nucleus of protons and neutrons (most of mass) is extremely
small even compared to the size of an atom. The rest of the 'almost empty space' of an atom is occupied by the negative
electrons, held by, and moving around the positive nucleus in their energy levels or 'shells'. The electrons are also pretty tiny
in mass too, compared to a proton or neutron. Bohr theorised the negative electrons can only exist in certain specific energy
levels (shells) held in place by the positive nucleus. All of these theories must, and have been, backed up by repeated and
varied experiments. As each new experiment was/is done, it must support the current theory or the theory needs to be
modified to take into account new discoveries. Some of these important experiments are described further down the page.
Even new experimental findings written up in research papers should be thoroughly peer reviewed, that is checked by
scientists of at least equal academic ranking to the researchers. That's how science works!
The number of protons in the nucleus of an atom decides what element that atom is.
e.g. if the atom has 3 protons in the nucleus, it cannot be anything except lithium!
Elements consist of one type of atom only.
Some more concise and handy styles to show the atomic composition of the same lithium atom
What subatomic particles make up atoms? What is their mass and charge?
The diagram above of a 'portrait of an atom' gives some idea on the structure of an atom (sometimes called the
Bohr Atomic Model), it also includes some important definitions and notation used to describe atomic structure
o The three fundamental particles you need to know are ...
o proton: particle mass = 1, electric charge = +1, the charged particle in the nucleus
o neutron: particle mass = 1, charge = 0, uncharged particle in the nucleus
o electron: particle mass = 1/1850 ~1/2000, electric charge = 1, NOT in nucleus but exist in electronic
energy levels around the nucleus (a sort of orbit, often described as a shell, see later).
o The nucleus of protons and neutrons is tiny, even compared to the tiny atom!
So most of the volume of an atom is where the electrons are, the diameter of the nucleus of protons
plus neutrons is about a ten thousandth of the diameter of an atom!
Since the nucleus is composed of positive protons and neutral neutrons, the nucleus itself must
be positive.
A neutral atom carries no overall charge because the number of positive protons equals the number
of negative electrons, and this information is given by the atomic/proton number.
Protons and neutrons are the 'nucleons' or 'subatomic' particles present in the minute positive nucleus
and the negative electrons are held by the positive protons in 'orbits' called energy levels or shells.
o Although the nucleus must be positive because of the positive protons (neutrons are neutral) an individual
atom is neutral because the number of electrons equals the number of protons so the charges 'cancel out'.
o If electrons are removed from an atom you get a positive ion and if electrons are added to an atom you get
a negative ion.
An ion, by definition, cannot be neutral.
Some important evidence for this 'picture' is obtained from alpha particle scattering experiments (see Appendix 1).
The atomic number (Z) is the number of protons in the nucleus and is also known as the proton number of the
particular element.
o Each element has its own atomic number, so all the atoms of a particular element have the same
atomic number.
It is the proton/atomic number (Z) that determines the number of electrons an element has, its specific
electron structure and therefore the specific identity of a particular element in terms of its physical and
chemical properties.
It cannot be overemphasised that it is the electronic structure that determines the chemical character of an
element, hence the proton/atomic number determines everything about a particular element
The mass number (A) is also known as the nucleon number, that is the number of particles in the nucleus of
a particular atomisotope (notes on isotopes definition and examples).
o Therefore the mass/nucleon number = sum of the protons plus neutrons in the nucleus.
o Since the mass of a proton or neutron equals 1, the mass number equals the mass of an atom to the
nearest whole number.
o Relative Atomic Mass is dealt with on a separate calculation page
The neutron number (N) = mass number proton/atomic number
In a neutral atom the number of protons (+) equals the number of electrons (), that is the number of positive
charges is equal to the number of negative charges.
o If not, and the atom has an overall surplus or deficiency electrical charge, and is the resulting electrically
charged particle called an ion e.g.
+
the positive sodium ion Na (11 protons, 10 electrons, excess positive protons)
or the negative chloride ion Cl (17 protons, 18 electrons, excess negative electrons)
for more details and examples see ionic bonding notes.
In the example above for lithium7, the nuclide notation states that
o before the chemical symbol of the element Li
o the top left number = nucleon/mass number = 7
o and the bottom left number = proton/atomic number = 3
o Similarly for ...
o
, atom of hydrogen1, symbol H, mass 1, just 1 proton and NO neutrons (only atom with no neutrons)
, atom of helium4, symbol He, mass 4, 2 protons, 4 2 = 2 neutrons
o
, atom of sodium, symbol Na, mass 23, 11 protons, 23 11 = 12 neutrons
The electrons are arranged in specific energy levels according to a set of rules (dealt with in section 3).
This description of an atom consisting of the relatively minute nucleus of protons and neutrons surrounded by
electrons in particular shells or energy levels is sometimes referred to as the Bohr Model of the atom, after the
great Danish scientist Niels Bohr (18851962), one of the brilliant founders of modern atomic theory.
Other examples of interpreting the nuclide notation and definition reminders:
o Top left number is the nucleon number or mass number (A = sum of protons + neutrons = nucleons)
o Bottom left number is the atomic number or proton number (Z = protons in nucleus)
o Electrons = protons if the atom is electrically neutral i.e. NOT an ion.
o The neutron number N = A Z i.e. mass/nucleon number atomic/proton number
Iron atom (isotope iron56), mass 56, 26 protons, 30 neutrons (56 26), 26 electrons
Cobalt atom (isotope cobalt59), mass 59, 27 protons, 32 neutrons (59 27), 27
electrons
Californium atom (isotope californium246), mass 246, 98 protons, 148 neutrons (246
98), 98 electrons
So, at this point we had better explain, slightly belatedly, what isotopes are!
2. ISOTOPES
WHAT ARE ISOTOPES? ARE THEY IMPORTANT?
Isotopes are atoms of the same element with different numbers of neutrons and therefore different masses
(different nucleon/mass numbers).
o This gives each isotope of a particular element a different mass or nucleon number, but, being the
same element they have the same atomic or proton number.
o They are also chemically identical, because they have the same number of electrons, hence the
same electron structure.
o Study the diagrams of the isotopes of carbon further down the page.
o Relative Isotopic Mass is dealt with on a separate calculation page
The phrase 'heavier' or 'lighter' isotope means 'bigger' or 'smaller' mass number for a particular element.
There are small physical differences between the isotopes e.g. the heavier isotope has a greater density or boiling
point, the lighter the isotope the faster it diffuses.
However, because they have the same number of protons (proton/atomic number) isotopes of a particular
element have the same electronic structure and identical chemistry.
Examples of isotopes are illustrated and described below.
Caution Note: Do NOT assume the word isotope means the atom it is radioactive, this depends on the stability
of the nucleus i.e. unstable atoms (radioactive) might be referred to as radioisotopes.
Many isotopes are extremely stable in the nuclear sense and NOT radioactive i.e. most of the atoms that make up
you and the world around you!
hydrogen1,
hydrogen2, and
hydrogen3 are the three isotopes of hydrogen with mass
numbers of 1, 2 and 3, with 0, 1 and 2 neutrons respectively. All have 1 proton, since all are hydrogen! Hydrogen1
is the most common, there is a trace of hydrogen2 (sometimes called deuterium) naturally but hydrogen3
(sometime called tritium) is very unstable and is used in atomic bombs nuclear fusion weapons.
1
2
3
o They are sometimes denoted more simply as H, H and H since the chemical symbol H means hydrogen
and therefore must have only one proton.
and
or He and He, are the two isotopes of helium with mass numbers of 3 and 4, with 1 and 2
neutrons respectively but both have 2 protons. Helium3 is formed in the Sun by the initial nuclear fusion process.
Helium4 is also formed in the Sun and as a product of radioactive alpha decay of an unstable nucleus.
o An alpha particle is a helium nucleus (mass 4, charge +2) and if it picks up two electrons it becomes a
stable atoms of the gas helium. For more details see
and
or Na and Na, are the two isotopes of sodium with mass numbers of 23 and 24, with
12 and 13 neutrons respectively but both have 11 protons in the nucleus and 11 surrounding electrons. Sodium23
is quite stable e.g. in common salt (NaCl, sodium chloride) but sodium24 is a radioisotope and is a gamma emitter
used in medicine as a radioactive tracer e.g. to examine organs and the blood system.
and
are the two nuclear symbols for the two most common and stable isotopes of the element
chlorine. They both have 17 protons in the nucleus and 3517 = 18 and 3717 = 20 neutrons respectively (and both
have 17 surrounding electrons).
and
are the two nuclide symbols for the two most common and stable isotopes of the element
bromine. They both have 35 protons in the nucleus and 7935 = 44 neutrons and 8135 = 46 neutrons respectively.
By coincidence, there are almost exactly 50% of each isotope present in naturally occurring bromine.
The three known isotopes of carbon
23
24
o
o
isotope
% abundance
o
o
o
carbon12
12
6C
98.9%, stable
carbon13
13
6C
1.1%, stable
carbon14
14
6C
trace, unstable
radioactive
The table of information on the three isotopes of carbon is illustrated by the diagrams above it.
Now is an appropriate point to introduce the concept and definition of relative atomic mass (Ar), which is
required for very accurate quantitative chemistry calculations.
The relative atomic mass of an element is the average mass of all the isotopes present compared to
12
1/12th of the mass of a carbon12 atom ( C = 12.00000 amu i.e. the standard).
When you average the masses of the isotopes of carbon, taking into account their relative
abundance (%), you arrive at a relative atomic mass of carbon of 12.011, Ar(C) = 12.011, though at
this academic level 12.0 is accurate enough!
The electrons are arranged in energy levels or shells around the nucleus and with 'orbits' on average increasing in
distance from the nucleus.
o The lowest energy levels are always filled first, you can think of the lower the shell, the nearer the nucleus,
and numbered 1, 2, 3 etc. as the shell gets further from the nucleus.
Each electron in an atom is in a particular energy level (or shell) and the electrons must occupy the lowest
available energy level (or shell) available nearest the nucleus.
When the level is full, the next electron goes into the next highest level (shell) available.
There are rules to learn about the maximum number of electrons allowed in each shell and you have to be able to
work out the arrangements for the first 20 elements (for GCSE students, upto at least 36 for Advanced level
students).
st
o The 1 shell can contain a maximum of 2 electrons (electrons 12)
o The 2nd shell can contain a maximum of 8 electrons (electrons 310)
o The 3rd shell also has a maximum of 8 electrons (electrons 1118)
th
th
th
o The 19 and 20 electrons go into the 4 shell, (required limit of GCSE knowledge).
o Remember the total electrons to be arranged equals the atomic/proton number for a neutral atom.
If you know the atomic (proton) number, you know it equals the number of electrons in a neutral atom, you
then apply the rules to work out the electron arrangement (configuration).
For elements 1 to 20 the electron arrangements/configurations are written out in the following manner:
o Note that each number represents the number of electrons in a particular shell, dots or commas are used to
separate the numbers of electrons in each shell. They are written out in order of increasing average distance
from the positive nucleus which holds these negative electrons in their energy levels (shells).
o The electron configurations are summarised below with reference to the periods of the periodic table and
in order of increasing atomic number.
For more see the Periodic Table and Electron Structure notes below.
o Period 1 elements 1 to 2 (2 elements)
the electron arrangement is written out simply as 1 or 2
o Period 2 elements 3 to 10 (8 elements)
o
o
o
o
electron arrangements of 2.1 to 2.8 (since 1st shell is full with 2 electrons i.e. the first number)
Period 3 elements 11 to 18 (8 elements)
denoted by 2.8.1 to 2.8.8 (1st,2nd full shells with 2,8 electrons)
Period 4 first two elements 19 to 20
written out as 2.8.8.1 and 2.8.8.2 (1st,2nd,3rd full shells with 2,8,8 electrons)
Reminder this is as far as GCSE students need to know, after that things get more complicated,
BUT only for advanced level students!
For example, after element 18, the 3rd shell can hold a maximum of 18 electrons!
The above is summarised in the diagram below
The electron shell arrangements are quoted in numbers e.g. 2.4 for C (carbon) but you need to be able to
draw electron diagrams showing the electronic structure of the atom.
Some examples are given below and GCSE/IGCSE/O level students need to be able to work and
draw the electronic structures of the first 20 elements.
You should notice that the number of shells used equals the period number of the element in the
periodic table.
They can be all worked by the 'shell filling' rules described above.
For the rest of Period 4 and other Periods you need a more
advanced electron configuration system
upto at least Z=36 using s, p, d and f orbital notation BUT for advanced level chemistry students
only!
Examples: diagram, symbol or name of element (Atomic Number = number of protons and the number of electrons in a
neutral atom), shorthand electron arrangement and a diagram to help you follow the numbers.
to
to
to
Only the first 2 of the 18 elements of Period 4 are shown above, the rule for 3rd shell changes from element 21 Sc onwards
(studied at Advanced level, so GCSE students don't worry!)
A few more 'snappy' examples given atomic number, work out electron configuration (abbreviated to e.c.)
Z = 3 e.c. 2.1 or Z = 7 e.c. = 2.5 or Z = 14 e.c. = 2.8.4 or Z = 19 e.c. = 2.8.8.1 etc. upto Z = 20
WHY ARE SOME ELECTRON ARRANGEMENTS ARE MORE STABLE THAN OTHERS?
WHICH ELECTRON ARRANGEMENTS ARE THE MOST STABLE AND WHICH ELECTRON ARRANGEMENTS
THE LEAST STABLE?
HOW DO ELECTRON ARRANGEMENTS RELATE TO THE REACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL ELEMENTS?
When an atom has its outer level full to the maximum number of electrons allowed, the atom is particularly stable
electronically and very unreactive.
o This is the situation with the Noble Gases: He is [2], neon is [2,8] and argon is [2,8,8] etc.
o There atoms are the most reluctant to lose, share or gain electrons in any sort of chemical interaction
because they are so electronically stable.
o For all elements most of their chemistry is about what outer electrons do or don't!
o [2], [2,8] and [2,8,8] etc. are known as the 'stable Noble Gas arrangements', and the atoms of other
elements try to attain this sort of electron structure when reacting to become more stable.
o More details on
Electron configuration notes for Advanced Level Chemistry Students
The most reactive metals have just one outer electron.
o These are the Group 1 Alkali Metals, lithium [2,1], sodium [2,8,1], potassium [2,8,8,1]
o With one outer shell electron, they have one more electron than a stable Noble Gas electron structure.
o So, they readily lose the outer electron when they chemically react to try to form (if possible) one of the
stable Noble Gas electron arrangements which is why atoms react in the first place!
o When Group 1 Alkali Metal atoms lose an electron they form a positive ion because the positive proton
number doesn't change, but with one negative electron lost, there is a surplus of one + charge e.g.
sodium atom ==> sodium ion
+
Na ==> Na
is [2.8.1] ==> [2.8] electronically
in fundamental particles [11p + 11e] ==> [11p + 10e]
IONS are atoms or group of atoms which carry an overall electrical charge i.e. not electrically
neutral.
The most reactive nonmetals are just one electron short of a full outer shell.
o These are the Group 7 Halogens, namely fluorine [2,7], chlorine [2,8,7] etc.
These atoms are one electron short of a stable full outer shell and seek an 8th outer electron to become
electronically stable yet again, this is why atoms react!
o They readily gain an outer electron, when they chemically react, to form one of the stable Noble Gas
electron arrangements either by sharing electrons (in a covalent bond) or by electron transfer forming a
singly charged negative ion (ionic bonding) e.g.
chlorine atom ==> chloride ion
Cl ==> Cl
is [2.8.7] ==> [2.8.8] electronically
in fundamental particles [17p + 17e] ==> [17p + 18e]
the positive proton number of Cl doesn't change but the chloride ion carries one extra negative
electron to give the surplus charge of a single on the ion.
EXTRA NOTE ON 'ATOMIC' NOTATION representation of isotopes of ions
Nuclide notation and ions (interpretation required for advanced level students only)
sodium24 isotope ion, 11 protons, 13 neutrons, 10 electrons (one electron lost to form a
positive ion)
sodium23 isotope ion, 11, protons, 12 neutrons, 10 electrons (one electron lost to form a
positive ion)
isotope sulfur32 in the form of the sulfide ion, 16 protons, 16 neutrons, 18 electrons (two electrons
gained to form the double charged negative ion)
For more on electron structure and chemical changes and compound formation see ...
o
GCSE/IGCSE/AS notes on CHEMICAL BONDING
and for more on metal and nonmetal reactivity see
o
The elements are laid out in order of Atomic Number that is the number of protons in the nucleus.
It is important to realise that the 'chemical structure' of the periodic Table (shown above), that is the chemical
similarity of vertical groups 'like' elements (apart from the Noble Gases), was known well before the electronic
structure of atoms was understood.
o In other words the elements are laid out in vertical columns (groups) and horizontal rows (periods) so that
chemically (usually) VERY similar elements appear under each other and there is a very good electronic
structure reason for this!
o However, it wasn't understood why they behaved in the same way chemically e.g. similar compound
formulae and reactions etc. nor was it understood at first why Noble Gases were so unreactive towards other
elements.
o BUT, once the electronic structure of atoms was understood, 'electronic' theories could then be applied to
explain the chemical similarity of elements in a vertical Group of the Periodic Table.
Originally they were laid out in order of ' relative atomic mass' (the old term was 'atomic weight'). This is not
correct for some elements now that we know their detailed atomic structure in terms of protons, neutrons and
electrons, and of course, their chemical and physical properties.
For example: Argon (at. no. 18, electrons 2,8,8) has a relative atomic mass of 40. Potassium (at. no. 19, electrons
2,8,8,1) has a relative atomic mass of 39. BUT Argon, in terms of its physical, chemical and electronic properties is
clearly a Noble Gas in Group 0. Likewise, potassium is clearly an Alkali Metal in Group 1.
Hydrogen, 1, H, does not readily fit into any group
A Group is a vertical column of chemically and physically similar elements e.g.
o Group 1 The Alkali Metals (Li, Na, K etc.) with one outer electron (one more than a Noble Gas structure),
o Group 7 The Halogens (F, Cl, Br, I etc.) with seven outer electrons (one short of a Noble Gas arrangement)
o and Group 0 The Noble Gases (He, Ne, Ar etc.). The group number equals the number of electrons in the
outer shell (e.g. chlorine's electron arrangement is 2.8.7, the second element down Group 7 on period 3).
A Period is a horizontal row of elements with a variety of properties (left to right goes from metallic to non
metallic elements. All the elements use the same number of electron shells which equals the period number (e.g.
sodium's electron arrangement 2.8.1, the first element in Period 3).
The ten elements Sc to Zn are called the Transition Metals Series and form part of a period between Group 2 and
Group 3 from Period 4 onwards.
Below are the electron arrangements for elements 1 to 20 set out in Periodic Table format (Hydrogen and The
Transition metals etc. have been omitted). When you move down to the next period you start to fill in the next shell
according to the maximum electrons in a shell rule (see previous section).
NOTE: In the most modern periodic table notation Groups 37 and 0 are numbered Groups 3 to 18.
o
o
o
o
o
o
The first element in a period has one outer electron (e.g. sodium Na 2.8.1), and the last element has a
full outer shell (e.g. argon Ar 2.8.8)
Apart from hydrogen (H, 1) and helium (He, 2) the last electron number is the group number (in the old
notation) and the number of shells used is equal to the Period number.
The periodicity of elements i.e. the repetition of very chemically similar elements in a group is due to the
repetition of a the same outer electron structure check out the last number from element 3 onwards.
More GCSE/IGCSE notes on the Periodic Table
and the
APPENDIX 1. The history of the atom concept and the Alpha Particle Scattering Experiment
(some of the ideas described here go above GCSE/IGCSE level!)
The Greeks Leucippus and Democritus ~400 BC wondered what was the result of continually dividing a substance i.e. what
was the end product or smallest bit i.e. what was left that was indivisible the word atomic is from Greek adjective meaning
'not divisible'.
The Greeks idea was not forgotten and later revived by Boyle and Newton but with little progress. However in 1808 Dalton
proposed his atomic theory that all matter was made up of tiny hard particles/spheres called atoms and the different types
of atoms (elements) combined together to give all the different substances of the physical world (all which of course is true,
except for the 'hard solid indivisible spheres'!). He also produced the first list of 'atomic weights' (we now call relative atomic
masses) on a scale based on hydrogen given the arbitrary value of 1 since it was lightest element known, and, as it
happens, correctly so.
J J Thompson Around 1897 proposed his 'plum pudding' theory based on the growing evidence that atoms were
themselves composed of even small more fundamental particles and the mass and charge of the proton and electron i.e.
atoms were not hard indivisible spheres. His experiments had shown that atoms contained small negatively charged particle
called electrons. From Thompson envisaged a plumb pudding atom consisting of a positively charged 'pudding' with just
enough lighter negatively charged electrons embedded in it to produce a neutral atom. The idea of positive particles
balancing the negative particles was correct but the relative size and nature of the nucleus were not.
Ernest Rutherford, Hans Geiger and Ernest Marsden (the latter two were students of Rutherford at Cambridge
University) conducted alpha particle scattering experiments (19021910, and described in detail below). These experiments
established
(i) minute nature of the nucleus even compared to the size of an atom
(ii) the nucleus was positive and the positive charge varied from element to element.
The Rutherford and GeigerMarsden scattering experiments (19021910).
When alpha particle beams are fired on very thin layers of metals (e.g. very fine gold
leaf) some rather surprising results were by scientists of the early 20th century.
o
By using a 360 charged particle detection system it was found that ...
3. most particles passed through undeflected (as if there was nothing there!)
2. a small proportion were deflected slightly (so there was something there!)
o
1. about 1 in 20,000 were 'bounced' back through an angle of over 90 , in other words
were reflected backwards, a totally unexpected result. So, whatever was there was
substantial, positively charged to cause the repulsion 'bounce', BUT not very big!
From a detailed mathematical analysis of the scattering results, the only 'model' which
could account for the pattern was an atom of ...
... mainly empty space (why most alpha particles passed through!),
... a positive centre (the nucleus) causing deflection (like charges repel, alpha particles
are positively charged and so were being repelled by the 'later to be discovered' positive
protons in the nucleus),
... a tiny dense centre of similar or greater charge or mass to an alpha particle (which
we now call the nucleus), and this is the modern picture of the 'nuclear atom'.
So an atom is quite well represented by the Bohr model of the atom diagram near the top of this page were we
started! Bohr's suggestion that the negative electrons can only exist in certain specific energy levels (shells) held in place by
the positive nucleus complimented the Rutherford model of the atom to gives a reasonably complete picture of an atom (at
least for this academic level!).
Earlier theories of atomic structure, e.g. the 'plum pudding' model in which 'protons' and 'electrons' were scattered or
arranged evenly across the atom, were superceded by this model. It was the only model that could explain the scattering of
the high speed alpha particles by a small dense and positive atomic centre.
Later experiments showed that the outer bits could be knocked off atoms and these had a very tiny mass and a negative
charge, in other words the electron!
Moseley studied the Xrays emitted by highly energisedionised atoms and from the Xray spectra of elements (the K alpha
line, K) he was able to deduce the electric charge of the nucleus which we now know is equal to the atomic number of
protons in the nucleus. Moseley showed that when atoms were bombarded with cathode rays (electrons) Xrays where
produced. It was found that the square root of the highest energy emission line (called the K alpha line, K ) gave a linear plot
with the apparent atomic number. However the plot of K against atomic weight (relative atomic mass) gave a zigzag plot.
However, there was still the problem of why the atomic mass and atomic number where different i.e. in the case of the lighter
elements, the atomic weight was often about twice the atomic number.
In 1919 Aston developed a cathode ray tube i.e. like those used by Wien and Thompson etc. into a 'mass spectrograph',
which we now know as a mass spectrometer GCSEAS atomic structure notes. This showed that atoms of the same
element had different masses but there was no experimental evidence that they had different atomic numbers (which of
course they didn't). In 1920 Rutherford suggested there might be a 'missing' neutral particle and in 1932 Chadwick
discovered the neutron by bombarding beryllium atoms with alpha particles which produced a beam of neutrons.
It was not until 1932 that the nature of the neutron was finally deduced by Chadwick and this completely explained the
nature of isotopes and backed up the ideas from Moseley's work that the fundamentally important number that characterises
an element is its atomic number and NOT the atomic mass.
See section 2. Radioactivity Notes page on other experiments with mixed particle beams and their separation.
7
3Li
2.1 The modern version of the Periodic Table is based on the electronic structure of atoms
With our knowledge of atomic structure the modern Periodic Table is now laid out in order of atomic/proton number
(Z) and any apparent anomalies sorted out.
The atomic/proton number of the nucleus (Z) decides which element the atom is, the number of electrons
surrounding the nucleus of a neutral atom and hence the element's chemistry which is based on the electron
configuration.
The full Periodic Table (Z = 1 to 112) is shown in section 2.4 with the element symbol, atomic/proton number (Z)
and another version of the Periodic Table (Z = 1 to 56) showing the electron configuration which is introduced
and explained in the next section 2.2.
o In these notes the convention Z = atomic/proton number is used extensively, its a handy shorthand.
Due to isotopic mass variations and their nuclear stability, the relative atomic mass does sometimes go 'up/down' as
you proceed through the Periodic Table.
How to use the advanced s, p, d (f) notation for the electron configuration/arrangement of atoms/ions is
outlined below, but no knowledge of quantum mechanics is required, but you do need to know how to work out
electron arrangements from the rules and a little knowledge of the shape of orbitals wouldn't go amiss! You do NOT
need to know the origin of the rules or know all about the four quantum numbers, BUT I can't stand pulling rules out
of a hat, so I have given a little theoretical introduction, if can't stand that, tough!
To accurately describe an electron in an atom requires four quantum numbers which arise from solutions to the
elaborate mathematical equations of quantum mechanics, which describe the exceedingly complex wave behaviour
of electrons.
o These four quantum numbers arise from solutions to the complex equations which describe the wave and
quantised behaviour of electrons surrounding the nucleus.
1
o The first three quantum numbers have 0 or +/ integer values and the fourth one is +/ /2)
The Pauli exclusion principle states that no electron in an atom can have the same four
quantum numbers, i.e. at least one must differ from electron to electron for a single atom.
The four quantum numbers are:
1.
The principal quantum energy level number n or shell (n = 1,2, 3 ...), often just referred to as 'the level'. It is
important to think of this as the principal energy level, i.e. the principal quantum level an electron can occupy.
2.
The subsidiary/azimuthal/angular quantum number, l, this defines the 'spatial' type of subshell orbital, (l = 0
to n1). often just referred to as 'the sublevel or more specifically the s/p/d/f sublevel' (see orbital diagrams later).
Again, it is important to think of this as a subenergy level of an electron.
For s orbital (l = 0), p orbital (l = 1), d orbital (l = 2) diagrams below, and for the f orbital (l = 3).
For a given principal quantum number the order of energy of the sublevel is s < p < d < f.
3.
The magnetic or spatial orientation (of the orbital) quantum number, m, in terms of x,y,z axis (m = l ... 0 ... l)
where l = the azimuthal quantum number 2. above and allows for each principal quantum level n,
one s orbital for n = 1, 2, 3 etc., three p orbitals per for n = 2, 3, 4 etc., 5 d orbitals for n =3, 4, 5 etc.
and seven orbitals for n = 4, 5, 6 etc.
See the orientation of the three p type orbitals and the five d type orbitals.
1
1
4.
The electron's spin, s, which has the value of + /2 or /2 and can be envisaged as the electron spinning
clockwise/anticlockwise in a full individual orbital.
Electrons possess spin and if an orbital is filled then the pair of electrons must have opposite spins
(spinpaired).
This due to Pauli exclusion principle, which states that no electron can have the same four quantum
numbers, since the other three quantum numbers would be the same for a specific orbital, it is the
1
spin quantum number which will differ (+/ /2).
The principal quantum electronic energy levels (n) can be split into sublevels denoted by s, b, d and f
depending on the number of electrons in the 'system'.
The 'space' in which the electron exists with its particular quantum level energy is called the atomic orbital and
each type, s, p, d or f has its own particular 'shape' or 'shapes'.
s atomic orbital
s orbitals have a spherical shell shape and the faint dark blue circle represents in crosssection,
the region of maximum electron density.
Only one s orbital exists for each principal quantum number denoted by 1s, 2s, 3s etc.
p orbitals
o
p orbitals are pairs of 'dumbbells' aligned along the x, y and z axis at 90 to each other.
There are three p orbitals for each principal quantum number from 2 onwards denoted by 2p, 3p
and 4p etc.
e.g. 2p can be composed of 2px, 2py and 2pz if all three orbitals for a particular principal
quantum number are occupied.
If a p subshell is full it holds a maximum of 3 x 2 = 6 electrons.
There is no 1p because quantum rules do not allow this.
d
atomic orbitals
d orbitals have complex shapes, I say no more except their relative alignment is important in
explaining the origin of colour in transition metal complexes.
There are five d orbitals for each principal quantum number from 3 onwards denoted by 3d, 4d, 5d
etc.
If a d subshell is full it contains a maximum of 5 x 2 = 10 electrons.
There are no 1d or 2d quantum levels, the quantum rules do not permit these.
o f orbitals orbital shapes not relevant at this level, the first is the 4f level and there are 7 orbitals holding a
maximum of 7 x 2 = 14 electrons if the subshell is full.
Don't worry too much about all the 'quantum' details above, the important features to
appreciate are described below.
To sum up 'numerically' from the quantum number rules, for the principal quantum number
n ...
o Each atomic orbital can hold a maximum of two electrons.
o For each principal quantum level n, the following rules apply ...
o for n = 1, there is just one subshell: 1s, maximum of 2 electrons,
o for n = 2 there are two subshells: 1 x 2s atomic orbital and 3 x 2p orbitals, maximum of 2 + 6 = 8
electrons,
for n = 3 there are three subshells: 1 x 3s,3 x 3p orbitals and 5 x 3d orbitals, maximum of 2 + 6 + 10 = 18
electrons,
o for n = 4 there are four subshells: 1 x 4s,3 x 4p orbitals, 5 x 4d orbitals and 7 x 4f orbitals, maximum of 2 +
6 + 10 + 14 = 32 electrons.
o However the order of filling is not this simple (see below, with visual diagrammatic help).
How do we work out electron the arrangement of an atom?
The arrangement of electrons in the shells and orbitals is called the electronic configuration or electron
arrangement/structure and is written out in a particular sequence.
3
The orbital electrons are denoted in the form of e.g. 2p
3
o means there are three electrons (superscript number )
o in the p subshell (the lower case letter)
o and in the second principal quantum level/shell (prefix number 2).
The quantum levels and associated orbitals are filled according to the Aufbau Principle which states that an
electron goes into the lowest available energy level providing the following 'subrules' are obeyed.
o The Pauli exclusion principle states that no two electrons can have the same four quantum numbers.
o Hund's Rule of maximum multiplicity states that, as far as is possible, electrons will occupy orbitals so
that they have parallel spins. This means if a set of subshell orbitals of the same energy level e.g. a 2p or
3d set, each orbital will be singly occupied before pairing (to minimise electron repulsion within a single
atomic orbital, i.e. a lower energy state than paired electron orbitals and unoccupied orbitals.
The orbitals are filled in a definite order to produce the system of lowest energy and any electron will go into
the lowest available energy level.
o The order of 'filling' for an electron configuration is shown in the diagram below.
o It uses is a simple diagrammatic convention to show an atomic orbital as a box.
o Electrons are shown as halfarrows (up/down to represent the different spin quantum
number s), see the 2nd diagram.
o
The order of filling (up to atomic number Z = 36, H to Kr) is 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 4s 3d 4p, up to a
total 36 electrons from Z = 1 to 36 i.e. the order of increasing energy of the subshell or energy
sublevel.
o Note the 'quirk' in order for filling the 3d subshell energy level (see also the diagram below).
o Until atomic number 21 (Sc) is reached, the 3d level is too high in energy and the electrons go into the 4s
level and then the 3d level is filled from Sc to Zn.
o This, and other 'quirks' I'm afraid, are a feature of the quantum complexity of multielectron systems, so just
learn the rules and get on with life!
After Z=30, the 'filling' of the 4p level begins with Ga (Z=31) and finishes with Kr (Z=36). After Z=36, and up to Z=56,
so after 4p the filling order is, 5s 4d 5p 6s, thus completing period and starting period 6 (and also repeating the
pattern of filling in period 4 including a 2nd block of metals, the 4d block.
2
2
6
2
6
3
2
o The diagram for vanadium (Z=23), 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 3d 4s is shown below.
o
o
*
Just a thought experiment do the following ...
'Empty' the 3d level of electron arrows and you get the diagram for calcium (Z =
20).
Fill up completely the 3d and 4p boxes with arrows and you get krypton (Z = 36)
The table in Part 2.3 shows how they are written out up to Z = 56 and a few others and note the orbital order when
writing out.
They are written out in strict order of principal quantum number 1, 2, 3 etc. and each principal quantum number is
followed by the s, p or d sublevels etc., and this is irrespective of the order of filling, i.e. when writing out the
configuration, you ignore the 3d filling 'quirk' described above.
Also in the table, some are written out in box diagram format, each box represents an orbital with a maximum of two
electrons of opposite spin (shown by the opposing arrows).
o Note the electrons only pair up when all suborbitals are filled separately with a single electron (this
minimises electron pair repulsion within an orbital).
Elements with one or two outer s electrons, and no outer p or d electrons etc., are called sblock elements
(Groups 1 and 2).
Elements with at least one outer p electron are called pblock elements (Groups 3 to 8/0).
Elements where the highest available d subshell is being filled are called dblock elements (*Transition
Metals) and similarly elements where the highest available f subshell is being filled are called fblock elements (the
Lanthanides and Actinides).
o * ScZn is the 3d block, BUT true transition elements form at least one chemically stable ion with a
partly filled subshell of d electrons.
3+
0
2+
10
2
Sc only forms Sc [Ar]3d , and Zn only forms Zn [Ar]3d 4s , so the true 3dblock transition
metals are from Ti to Cu.
Can you spot the other electronic 'quirks' for chromium and copper?
Explanation: It would appear that a halffilled 3d subshell (Cr) or a full 3d subshell (Cu) is a tad
more stable than a full 4s level.
Quantum theory dictates that electrons can only have certain specific 'quantised' energies and any electronic
level change requires a specific energy change i.e. energy quanta absorbed or energy quanta emitted.
o Any electron will occupy the lowest available energy level according to the Aufbau principle (previously
described).
o The order of 'filling' up to atomic number 56 from the lowest to highest quantum level is ...
1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 4s 3d 4p 5s 4d 5p 6s
o Writing out electron configurations for atoms
o BUT first, how to work out the electron arrangement from the atomic/proton number,
o AND then how to write out the electron configuration.
o To work out an electron arrangement for an atom, you start with the atomic number, then 'fill in' the levels
and sublevels according to the rule.
The electron configuration is written out in order of,
firstly, the principal quantum energy level
then within this level in s, p, d, f order
and the total number of electrons in each subenergy level is shown as a super
script.
o Example 1. sodium, Na, Z = 11
o 1s filled (2e) 9e's left, 2s filled (2e's) 7e left, 2p filled (6e's) 1e left, last electron goes into the 3s level.
o According to the notation rule this is written as ...
2
2
6
1
o 1s 2s 2p 3s (2.8.1 in simplified shell notation)
o Example 2. vanadium, V, Z = 23
o 1s filled (2e's) 21e's left, 2s filled (2e's) 19e left, 2p filled (6e's) 13e's left, 3s filled (2e's) 11e's left, 3p filled
(6e's) 5e's left, 4s filled (2e's) 3e's left, last 3e's go into 3d level.
o
o
o
o
o
o
So, although it physically and chemically it fits in a bit more with Group 7/17 than
Group 1, it does not really fit convincingly in any group, and many modern
periodic tables show it on its own at the top on period 1. I'm afraid I'm irritated
when its put at the top of Group 1 or 7 in the periodic table.
Reaction of element with oxygen:
o Explosive reaction when ignited in an air mixture, a jet of the gas burns with very pale blue flame to form the
colourless covalent liquid molecule, water.
2H2(g) + O2(g) ==> 2H2O(l)
Reaction of element with chlorine:
o Explosive if the mixture is heated or subjected to uv light. The colourless covalent gas hydrogen chloride is
formed.
H2(g) + Cl2(g) ==> 2HCl(g)
Reaction of hydrogen with metals
o Hydrogen will combine with alkali metals to form a series of Group 1 hydrides
H2(g) + 2M(s/l) ==> 2MH(s)
These are white ionic compounds.
Hydrides are formed with other reactive metals but their chemical structure is more complex, with
different degrees of ionic/covalent character.
Reaction of chloride with water:
o Hydrogen chloride gas dissolves to form the strong hydrochloric acid (100% ionised).
+
HCl(g) + H2O(l) ==> H3O (aq) + Cl (aq)
Other comments:
o In chemistry, its 'proton form' is the basis of the concept of Bronsted-Lowry acids and bases.
o An acid is a proton donor e.g. hydrogen chloride.
o A base is a proton acceptor e.g. ammonia.
+
NH3(g) + HCl(g) ==> NH4 Cl (s)
The hydrogen donates a proton to the ammonia molecule.
o Section 3.4 shows how the heavier elements are built up from hydrogen isotopes via nuclear reactions.
Links to other pages on this site:
o Preparation of gas : Test for gas : Acid-Base theory :
o Use in ammonia-fertiliser production or margarine production :
Maximum of two elements in period 1 as there is a maximum of two electrons allowed in the 1st principal quantum
level (1s) and only an s-orbital energy sub-level is allowed.
Both elements are non-metallic gases, but a considerable difference in chemical reactivity!
Hydrogen, as outlined above, has quite an extensive chemistry ie combines with all non-metals except the noble
gases and can also combine with some reactive metals eg the group 1 alkali metals.
Helium, with one full shell only (outer = inner !) has the highest ionisation energy of any element and is chemically
the most stable and least reactive of any element in the periodic table and has no meaningful
chemistry.
A
ZX,
1
1H
1
0n
1
0n
3
1H
3
2He
+ 0n ==>
2He
1
1H
==>
2He
+ 0n
From helium the heavier elements are formed as bigger and bigger nuclei fuse together.
4
[ 4Be] +
2He
==>
12
6C
and from carbon-12, oxygen-16 and neon-20 are formed e.g. via
4
2He
12
6C
12
6C
==>
==>
20
10Ne
16
8O
4
2He
238
and so on, until even small amounts of 92U are eventually formed but require the highest of temperature e.g. in a
super-nova explosion of giant stars a lot bigger than our sun!
Many isotopes of elements after lead, 82Pb are unstable. After uranium, 92U, the vast majority of the isotopes of the elements
of atomic number 93+ are inherently unstable. They will not have survived even if they were formed billions of years ago in
the Sun, and retained or formed in the initial 'spin-off' material that formed the 'very early' Earth. However, the advent of
nuclear reactors has enabled up to kg quantities of e.g. plutonium, 94Pu (used in nuclear reactors and weapons) and
americium, 95Am (used in smoke alarms) to be produced. Cyclotrons, particle bombardment linear accelerators, have
enabled 'super-heavy' elements up to Z = 118? to be 'synthesised', but only a few atoms at a time (The Russia-US space
race seems to have been partly replaced by 'who can synthesize the biggest atom'.
In the case of SiCl4, 3d orbitals can be used to accept a lone pair from water, so providing a
mechanistic route for hydrolysis to occur. (compare with silicon).
Reaction of element with water:
o No reaction with cold water but red hot carbon reacts with steam to form carbon monoxide and hydrogen.
C(s) + H2O(g) ==> CO(g) + H2(g)
Other comments:
o All of organic chemistry is based on the compounds of carbon except for the oxides and carbonates.
Neon
513
900
801
1086
1402
1314
1681
2081
152
(met)
111 (met)
88
(cov)
77
(cov)
70 (cov)
66
(cov)
64 (cov)
51
(cov)
0.98
1.57
2.04
2.55
3.04
3.44
3.98
4.84
454
1551
2573
3820
63
55
54
24
1620
2760
3932
5100
77
90
85
27
0.150
0.250
<0.001
0.001
<0.001
<0.001
<0.001
<0.001
0.5
1.8
2.3
2.3
<0.1
<0.1
<0.1
<0.1
-3
Density (g cm )
The data is plotted below with explanations and comments (Z = proton/atomic number for the x axis)
Above each period graph is the corresponding periodicity graph for the whole of the periodic table
(g)
+e
-1
The energy required to remove the most loosely bound electron (kJmol ) from
the gaseous atoms at 298K/1atm.
The peaks correspond with the Group 0/18 Noble Gases at the end of a
period and the troughs with the Group 1 Alkali Metals at the start of a
period.
As you go across the period from one element to the next, the positive nuclear
charge is increasing by one unit as the atomic/proton number increases by
one unit and the charge is acting on electrons in the same principal quantum
level. The effective nuclear charge can be considered to be equal to the
number of outer electrons (this is very approximate and NOT a rule) and this
is increasing from left to right as no new quantum shell is added i.e. no extra
shielding. Therefore the outer electron is increasingly more strongly held by
the increasing positive charge of the nucleus and so, increasingly, more
energy is needed remove it.
So, for Period 2, the Group1 Alkali Metal (lithium, lowest Z) has the lowest 1st ionisation energy and the Group 0/18
Noble Gas (neon, highest Z) has the highest 1st ionisation energy value and most values follow the general trend of
increasing from left to right across period 2.
However there are two anomalies in the atomic number versus 1st ionisation energy graphs for period 2.
It should be first pointed out that these anomalies are due to the complex behaviour of the quantum levels in multi-electron
systems - do not expect any perfect trends in chemistry, thanks to quantum physics!
2
==>
The anomalously low value for boron is considered to be due to the first time a 2p electron is shielded by the full 2s sub-shell
and, more importantly, the 2p electron is a bit further away on average from the nucleus than the 2s electrons (so less
strongly bound). The effect overrides the effect of increasing proton number i.e. the increase in positive nuclear charge from
Be to B. However, after the kink, the continued increase in nuclear charge ensures the Period 2 trend for the 1st ionisation
energy continues as expected until oxygen, the 2nd anomaly.
==>
Prior to the 4th 2p electron, the other three p electrons occupy separate p sub-orbitals (Hund's Rule of maximum multiplicity)
to minimise repulsion between adjacent orbitals. The anomalously low value for oxygen is considered to be due to the effect
of the first pairing of electrons in the p orbitals producing a repulsion effect that overrides the effect of increasing proton
number (increase in positive nuclear charge). From the 'kink', the Period 2 trend for the 1st ionisation energy continues as
expected from oxygen to neon with increase in nuclear charge.
You see the same anomalous pattern in Period 3
So, in the covalent bond M -X , X has the greater electronegativity e.g. the polar bond C -F in covalent CF4.
This has major consequence on the type of bonding from ionic oxides and chlorides to non-metallic covalent oxides and
+ chlorides. If the difference is large an ionic bond results. e.g. Li F
M X ionic bond, M -X
polar bond and M-X a relatively non-polar bond (no partial charges shown)
Element
Lithium
Beryllium
Boron
Carbon
Nitrogen
Oxygen
Fluorine
Neon
old/latest Group
3/13
4/14
5/15
6/16
7/17
0/18
ZSymbol
3Li
4Be
5B
6C
7N
8O
9F
10Ne
Structure of
element
solid
metallic
lattice of
+
Li and
free e
solid
metallic
lattice of
2+
Be and
free e
solid giant
covalent
lattice Cn
small
gaseous
covalent
diatomic
molecule
N2
small
gaseous
covalent
diatomic
molecule
O2
small
gaseous
covalent
diatomic
molecule
F2
gaseous
single
atoms
Electron
configuration
1s 2s
common
oxidation states
in compounds
e.g. in oxides,
chlorides,
hydrides
1s 2s
solid giant
covalent
lattice Bn
1s 2s 2p
+1
+2
+3
max +1
max +2
max +3
1s 2s 2p
+4, (+2 in
CO, -4 to +4
in organic
compounds)
max +4
1s 2s 2p
-1 to +5
(max), -3,
+3 & +5
most
common
1s 2s 2p
-2, -1, +2 in
F2O
1s 2s 2p
1s 2s 2p
-1
max +2
max +5
Electronegativity
of element
0.98
1.57
2.04
2.55
3.04
3.44
3.98
4.84
Formula of
oxides
Li2O
BeO
B2O3
CO2 (CO)
N2O, NO,
N2O3, NO2,
N2O5
O2, O3
F2O
ionic
lattice
ionic lattice
with
covalent
character
giant
covalent
lattice
gaseous
small
covalent
molecules
gaseous
small
covalent
molecules
gaseous
small
covalent
molecules
gaseous
small
covalent
molecule
2.46
1.87
1.40
0.89
0.44
0.00
0.54
O-O
O -F
Bonding and
structure of
oxides
electronegativity
difference X-O
(O is 3.44)
nature of bond
Formula of
chlorides
bonding and
structure of
chlorides
electronegativity
difference X-Cl
(Cl is 3.16)
nature of bond
Formula of
hydride
Li O
2-
Be -O
B -O
C=O
N -O
BeCl2
BCl3
CCl4
NCl3
Cl2O or
OCl2
ClF or FCl
ionic
lattice
layered
covalent
lattice
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
small
covalent
liquid
molecule
small
covalent
liquid
molecule
non-polar
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
2.18
1.29
1.12
0.61
0.12
0.00
0.82
LiCl
Li Cl
LiH
Be -Cl
BeH2
B -Cl
BH3?, B2H6
etc.
C -Cl
CH4
N-Cl
Cl-Cl
Cl -F
NH3
H2O or OH2
HF or FH
bonding and
structure of
hydride
electronegativity
difference X-H
(H is 2.20) nature
of bond
ionic
lattice
layered
covalent
polymer
lattice
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
1.22
0.63
0.16
0.35
Li H
Be -H
B-H
C-H
1.02
1.24
1.78
N -H
O -H
H -F
(aq)
The chemical character of the oxides - reaction with water, acids and alkalis
o Lithium oxide Li2O is basic and forming the alkali lithium hydroxide in water and this gives salts with acids.
Li2O(s) + H2O(l) ==> 2LiOH(aq)
LiOH(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> LiCl(aq) + H2O(l)
o Beryllium oxide BeO has no reaction but is amphoteric and forms salts with acids and alkalis.
BeO(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> BeCl2(aq) + H2O(l)
BeO(s) + 2NaOH(aq) + H2O(l) ==> Na2[Be(OH)4](aq)
o Boron oxide B2O3 is weakly acidic and reacts with strong alkalis to form borate salts.
o Carbon dioxide CO2 is weakly acidic forming salts with alkalis e.g.
CO2(aq) + NaOH(aq) ==> NaHCO3(aq) + H2O(l)
o Nitrogen(I) oxide N2O (dinitrogen oxide) and nitrogen(II) oxide NO (nitrogen monoxide) are neutral oxides,
but nitrogen(III) oxide N2O3, nitrogen(IV) oxide NO2 (nitrogen dioxide) and nitrogen(V) oxide N2O5
are moderately to strongly acidic oxides.
Generally speaking, in a series of oxides of the same element, the higher the oxidation state of X in
a 'XxOy' series, the more acidic is the oxide.
Nitrogen(V) oxide reacts with water to form nitric(V) acid,
N2O5(l) + H2O(l) ==> 2HNO3(aq)
and nitric(V) acid is neutralised by alkali to form salts e.g.
2HNO3(aq) + NaOH(aq) ==> 2NaNO3(aq) + H2O(l)
o Oxygen(II) fluoride (oxygen difluoride) F2O is also acidic in principal but I don't know if it reacts with water?
o So, the general patterns across the period from left to right are
o ionic lattice bonding ==> giant covalent structure ==> small covalent molecules
The change in bonding character from ionic to covalent in the oxide follows the decreasing
difference in electronegativity between that of the element and oxygen.
o In terms of chemical character ...
o basic oxide => amphoteric oxide => weakly acidic oxide => strongly acidic oxide
o and metal basic oxides ==> metal amphoteric oxides ==> non-metal oxides
o This is chemically characteristic of metallic compound ==> non-metallic compound character.
o -
(aq)
Period 2
[Ne] 10e
2
2
6
1s 2s 2p
total nuclear
charge
+6
+7
radius in
picometre
(pm)
260
171
4-
3-
Group
3/13
Period 3
-
(Ne)
Na
Mg
+8
+9
(+10)
+11
+12
+13
140
136
(38112*)
95
65
50
2-
Group 2
2+
Al
3+
name of ion carbide nitride oxide fluoride (neon) sodium magnesium aluminium
Excluding the noble gases themselves, there is a clear pattern of decreasing ionic radius with increase in
nuclear charge (+ atomic/proton number) for the two isoelectronic series tabulated above.
From left to right the proton/electron ratio is steadily increasing so that the electrons are experiencing an
increasingly greater attractive force of the nucleus for the same number of electrons, hence the steady
decrease in radii for an isoelectronic series.
* all sorts of values are quoted for noble gas radii e.g. atomic, covalent and ionic, but most don't fit in the pattern
above which is quite clear for all the cations and anions listed.
More isoelectronic radii are at the end of the Period 3 survey pages or the end of the Period 4 survey pages.
2+
2-
Burns brightly when heated in air to form a white powder of ionic magnesium oxide Mg O when heated
strongly in air.
2Mg(s) + O2(g) ==> 2MgO(s)
Reaction of oxide with water:
o It is slightly soluble in water, and is a basic oxide forming an alkaline solution of magnesium hydroxide
2+
o Mg (OH )2, of about pH12.
MgO(s) + H2O(l) ==> Mg(OH)2(aq)
Reaction of oxide with acids:
o Behaves as a basic oxide dissolving to form the chloride, sulphate and nitrate salt in the relevant dilute
acid.
o MgO(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MgCl2(aq) + H2O(l)
o MgO(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> MgSO4(aq) + H2O(l)
o MgO(s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> Mg(NO3)2(aq) + H2O(l)
+
2+
o In all cases the ionic equation is: MgO(s) + 2H (aq) ==> Mg (aq) + H2O(l)
Reaction of oxide with strong bases/alkalis:
o None, sodium oxide is ONLY basic.
Reaction of element with chlorine:
2+
o Forms colourless solid ionic magnesium chloride, Mg (Cl )2, when heated in chlorine.
Mg(s) + Cl2(g) ==> MgCl2(s)
Reaction of chloride with water:
o The salt dissolves in water forming a nearly neutral solution of about pH6.
2+
MgCl2(s) + aq ==> Mg (aq) + 2Cl (aq)
o or more correctly ...
2+
MgCl2(s) + 6H2O(l) ==> [Mg(H2O)6] (aq) + 2Cl (aq)
o The solution is slightly acidic, because the hexa-aqa magnesium ion can donate a proton to a water
+
molecule forming the oxonium ion, more simply H (aq).
2+
+
+
[Mg(H2O)6] (aq) + H2O(l)
[Mg(H2O)5OH] (aq) + H3O (aq)
Reaction of element with water:
o Very slow reaction with cold water to form hydrogen (bubbles form slowly on the surface) and alkaline
magnesium hydroxide.
Mg(s) + 2H2O(l) ==> Mg(OH)2(aq) + H2(g)
o Ignited magnesium will continue to burn in steam to form the white powder of magnesium oxide and
hydrogen gas and you get the same reaction if steam is passed over heated magnesium.
Mg(s) + H2O(g) ==> MgO(s) + H2(g)
Other comments:
o -
o
o
Burns when heated strongly in chlorine gas to form the white solid aluminium chloride on heating in
chlorine gas.
2Al(s) + 3Cl2(g) ==> 2AlCl3(s)
*
It is often a faint yellow in colour, due to traces of iron forming iron(III) chloride.
Aluminium chloride is a curious substance in its behaviour. The solid, AlCl3, consists of an ionic
3+
o
lattice of Al ions, each surrounded by six Cl ions, BUT on heating, at about 180 C, the thermal
kinetic energy of vibration of the ions in the lattice is sufficient to cause it break down and
sublimation takes place (s ==> g). In doing so the co-ordination number of the aluminium changes
from six to four to form the readily vapourised covalent dimer molecule, Al2Cl6, shown above.
Reaction of chloride with water:
o With a little water it rapidly, and exothermically hydrolyses to form aluminium hydroxide and nasty fumes of
hydrogen chloride gas.
AlCl3(s) + 3H2O(l) ==> Al(OH)3(s) + 3HCl(g)
o However, if a large excess of water is rapidly added, a weakly acidic solution of aluminium chloride is
formed, with the minimum of nasty fumes!
3+
AlCl3(s) + aq ==> Al (aq) + 3Cl (aq)
3+
or more correctly: AlCl3(s) + 6H2O(l) ==> [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3Cl (aq)
o The solution is slightly acidic, because the hexa-aqa aluminium ion can donate a proton to a water molecule
forming the oxonium ion.
3+
2+
+
[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + H2O(l)
[Al(H2O)5OH] (aq) + H3O (aq)
Reaction of element with water:
o None due to protective oxide layer.
Reactions of the hexa-aqua aluminium ion:
o It gives a gelatinous white precipitate with sodium hydroxide or ammonia solution which displays
amphoteric behaviour by dissolving in excess strong alkali (NaOH(aq), NOT NH3(aq)) and acids.
3+
Al (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> Al(OH)3(s)
3+
or [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)3(H2O)3] + 3H2O(l)
The hydroxide readily dissolves in acids to form salts:
+
3+
Al(OH)3(s) + 3H (aq) ==> Al (aq) + 3H2O(l)
+
3+
or more elaborately: [Al(OH)3(H2O)3] + 3H3O (aq)
[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3H2O(l)
Thus showing amphoteric behaviour, since the hydroxide ppt. also dissolves in
excess strong alkali (below).
3+
3 [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 6OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) + 6H2O(l) (from original aqueous ion)
3 or [Al(OH)3(H2O)3](s) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) + 3H2O(l) (from hydroxide ppt.)
3 or more simply Al(OH)3(s) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) (from hydroxide ppt.)
o With aqueous sodium carbonate solution, the hydroxide ppt. is formed, and, because of its acidic
nature, bubbles of carbon dioxide gas are evolved.
3+
22+
2[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + CO3 (aq)
2[Al(H2O)5(OH)] (aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
this process of proton donation continues until the gelatinous ppt. [Al(OH)3(H2O)3](s) is formed, but
will not dissolve in excess of the weak base/alkali.
See Appendix 1 in Transition Metal Chemistry pages for more examples and equations etc.
No Cr2(CO3)3 is formed because of the acid-base reaction above, due to the acidity of the
3+
3+
chromium(III) ion. Note the similarly highly charged and small ions Cr and Fe behave in the
same way.
o
o
Both oxides dissolve in alkalis to form a whole series of phosphate(III) and phosphate(V) salts.
with excess strong bases like sodium hydroxide, the simplified equations are:
P4O6(s) + 12NaOH(aq) ==> 4Na3PO3(aq) + 6H2O(l) sodium phosphate(III) formed from phosphorus(III)
oxide
3 ionic equation: P4O6(s) + 12OH (aq) ==> 4PO3 (aq) + 6H2O(l)
P4O10(s) + 12NaOH(aq) ==> 4Na3PO4(aq) + 6H2O(l) sodium phosphate(V) formed from phosphorus(V)
oxide
3 ionic equation: P4O10(s) + 12OH (aq) ==> 4PO4 (aq) + 6H2O(l)
If the empirical formulae P2O3 and P2O5 are used, just halve all the balancing numbers.
Other than using excess sodium hydroxide, other salts can be formed.
e.g. P4O10(s) + 4NaOH(aq) + 2H2O(l) ==> 4NaH2PO4(aq) sodium dihydrogen phosphate(V)
or P4O10(s) + 8NaOH(aq) ==> 4Na2HPO4(aq) + 2H2O(l) disodium hydrogen phosphate(V)
o Reaction of the chlorides with water:
o Phosphorus(III) chloride hydrolyses rapidly and exothermically to form phosphoric(III) acid.
PCl3(l) + 3H2O(l) ==> H3PO3(aq) + 3HCl(aq)
o Phosphorus(V) chloride initially hydrolyses to form phosphorus oxychloride and hydrochloric acid.
PCl5(s) + H2O(l) ==> POCl3(aq) + 2HCl(aq)
Then on boiling the aqueous solution, phosphoric(V) acid is formed and more hydrochloric acid.
POCl3(aq) + 3H2O(l) ==> H3PO4(aq) + 3HCl(aq)
overall: PCl5(s) + 4H2O(l) ==> H3PO4(aq) + 5HCl(aq)
Reaction of element with water:
o None.
Other comments:
o -
SO2(aq) + H2O(l)
H (aq) + HSO3 (aq)
o Sulphur trioxide reacts very violently and exothermically to form the oily liquid, strong sulphuric acid.
SO3(g) + H2O(l) ==> H2SO4(l)
In water, the sulphuric acid is almost fully ionised.
+
2 H2SO4(aq) + 2H2O(l) ==> 2H3O (aq) + SO4 (aq)
Reaction of oxide with acids:
o None, only acidic in nature.
Reaction of oxide with bases/alkalis:
o Sulphur dioxide dissolves in strong bases to form sulphites/sulphate(IV)s
o 2NaOH(aq) + SO2(g) ==> Na2SO3(aq) + H2O(l) formation of sodium sulphite/sulphate(IV)
2o ionic equation: 2OH (aq) + SO2(g) ==> SO3 (aq) + H2O(l)
o You would NOT attempt to react sulphur trioxide with water, the reaction is very violent and exothermic.
o but theoretically: 2NaOH(aq) + SO3(g) ==> Na2SO4(aq) + H2O(l)
Reaction of element with chlorine:
o When chlorine is passed over molten sulphur a variety of chlorides are formed.
o The main product is disulphur dichloride
o 2S(s) + Cl2(g) ==> S2Cl2(l) (SiCl2, SiCl4 also possible)
Reaction of chloride with water:
Slowly hydrolyses in water, via a complex reaction, to form an acid solution of several products (not meant to
be a balanced equation).
S2Cl2(g) + H2O(l) ==> HCl(aq), S(s), SO2(aq), H2SO3(aq), H2SO4(aq), H2S(aq) - complex redox/hydrolysis
reaction!
Reaction of element with water:
o None.
Other comments:
o Z = 17 Chlorine Cl in Group 7/17 The Halogens
Cl2(g) + H2O(l)
HClO(aq) + HCl(aq)
or more accurately and ionically ...
Cl2(g) + 2H2O(l)
Other comments:
o -
HClO(aq) + H3O
(aq)
+ Cl (aq)
496
738
186
160 (metal)
(metal)
Silicon
Phosphorus
Sulfur
Chlorine
Argon
577
786
1080
1000
1251
1520
143
(metal)
117
(covalent)
110
(covalent)
104
99
94 (covalent
(covalent) (covalent) -theoretical)
Electronegativity
(Pauling scale)
0.93
1.31
1.61
1.90
2.19
2.58
3.16
3.20
371
922
934
1683
317
390
172
84
1156
1363
2740
2628
553
718
239
87
Relative electrical
conductivity
0.218
0.224
0.382
0.001
<0.001
<0.001
<0.001
<0.001
1.0
1.7
2.7
2.3
1.8
2.1
<0.1
<0.1
-3
Density (g cm )
The data is plotted below with explanations and comments (Z = proton/atomic number for the x axis)
Above each period graph is the corresponding periodicity graph for the whole of the periodic table
(g)
+e
-1
The energy required to remove the most loosely bound electron (kJmol )
==>
The anomalously low value for aluminium is considered to be due to the first time a 3p electron is shielded by the full 3s subshell and, more importantly, the 3p electron is a bit further away on average from the nucleus than the 3s electrons (so less
strongly bound). The effect overrides the effect of increasing proton number i.e. increase in positive nuclear charge from Mg
to Al. However, after the kink, the continued increase in nuclear charge ensures the Period 3 trend for the 1st ionisation
energy continues as expected until sulfur, the 2nd anomaly.
2
==>
Prior to the 4th 3p electron, the other three p electrons occupy separate p sub-orbitals (Hund's Rule of maximum multiplicity)
to minimise repulsion between adjacent orbitals. The anomalously low values for sulphur is considered to be due to the
effect of the first pairing of electrons in the 3p orbitals producing a repulsion effect that overrides the effect of increasing
proton number (increase in positive nuclear charge). From the 'kink', the Period 3 trend for the 1st ionisation energy
continues as expected from sulfur to argon with increase in nuclear charge.
You see the same anomalous pattern in Period 2
So, in the covalent bond M -X , X has the greater electronegativity e.g. the polar bond Si -Cl in covalent SiCl4.
This has major consequence on the type of bonding from ionic oxides and chlorides to non-metallic covalent oxides and
+
chlorides. If the difference is large an ionic bond results. e.g. Na Cl
M X ionic bond, M -X
polar bond and M-X a relatively non-polar bond (no partial charges shown)
Element
Sodium
Magnesium
Aluminium
Silicon
Phosphorus
Sulfur
Chlorine
Argon
old/latest Group
3/13
4/14
5/15
6/16
7/17
0/18
ZSymbol
Structure of
element
electron
configuration
11Na
12Mg
[Ne]3s
electronegativity
of element
0.93
formula of oxides
Na2O,
Na2O2
bonding and
structure of
oxides
ionic
lattice
2.51
electronegativity
difference X-O (O
is 3.44) nature of Na+ O22bond
or O2
NaCl
[Ne]3s
max +4
max +5
1.31
1.61
1.90
2.19
MgO
Al2O3
SiO2
ionic lattice
ionic lattice
solid
covalent
giant
structure
2.13
1.83
1.54
Mg
2+
2-
Mg
2+
Al
3+
2-
AlCl3
1.85
electronegativity
difference X-H (H
is 2.20) nature of
bond
Cl
Si -O
Mg -H
Al
3+
1.26
-
Cl
0.59
-
P -O
1.25
-
Al -H
[Ne]3s 3p
2.58
3.16
3.20
SO2, SO3
Cl2O,
ClO2,
Cl2O6,
Cl2O7
S -O
S2Cl2, ??
0.28
0.58
-
gaseous
single
atoms
at Xe can
-2, -2, +4, -1, +1, +3, get max of
+6
+5, +7
+8
compounds
but not
max +6
max +7
here!
0.86
PCl3, PCl5
Cl-O
Cl2
0.00
-
Si -Cl
P -Cl
S -Cl
SiH4
PH3
H2S
HCl
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
small
covalent
gaseous
molecule
0.30
0.01
0.38
0.96
Si-H
P-H
H -S
'polymer-like' 'polymer-like'
small
structure of
structure of
ionic
covalent
intermediate intermediate
lattice
gaseous
ionic/covalent ionic/covalent
molecule
nature
nature
Na H
[Ne]3s 3p [Ne]3s 3p
solid
covalent covalent
covalent
small
small
small
gaseous gas/liquid
molecules molecules molecules
1.25
18Ar
ionic lattice,
covalent
vaporises to covalent
liquid
covalent
small
covalent
small
covalent
small
diatomic
dimer
liquid
small
liquid
gaseous
molecules molecules molecules molecules
molecule
Al2Cl6
AlH3
0.89
P4O6, P4O10
SiCl4
1.55
MgH2
1.27
[Ne]3s 3p
max +3
2.23
NaH
max +2
MgCl2
[Ne]3s 3p
+3, +5
electronegativity
difference X-Cl
(Cl is 3.16) nature
of bond
17Cl
solid
gaseous
solid small
small
small
covalent
covalent covalent
molecules
molecules molecules
P4
S8
Cl2
+4
ionic lattice
Na H
[Ne]3s 3p
16S
+3
ionic
lattice
bonding and
structure of
hydride
15P
+2
bonding in
chlorides
Formula of
hydride
14Si
solid
metallic
solid
solid metallic solid metallic
lattice
giant
2+
3+
lattice of Al
+ lattice of Mg
of Na
covalent
and free e
and free e
and
lattice Sin
free e
common
+1
oxidation states
e.g. in oxides,
chlorides, hydrides max +1
formula of
chlorides
13Al
Cl-Cl
H -Cl
Sodium Na, magnesium Mg and aluminium Al are silvery solids, with a metal lattice structure, high boiling
points and are good conductors of heat/electricity due to the delocalised free electrons moving between the
immobile metal ions.
The melting/boiling points increase from Na ==> Mg ==> Al due to 1 ==> 2 ==> 3 potential number
of delocalised electrons that may contribute to bonding.
o Si has a non-metallic giant covalent structure based on a tetrahedral arrangement of S-Si bonds and is a
poor conductor of heat/electricity.
The strong 3D bonding gives silicon a high melting/boiling point and great hardness.
o Phosphorus P4, sulfur S8 and chlorine Cl2 are simple-small covalent molecules and Ar consists of single
atoms. The molecules are only held together by the weakest of the intermolecular forces, namely the
instantaneous dipole - induced dipole forces, and consequently have very low melting/boiling points.
From left to right the elements become less metallic and more non-metallic.
o Electron configuration and oxidation states
2
2
6
1
2
2
6
2
6
o Electron configurations of 2,8,1 or 1s 2s 2p 3s to 2,8,8 or 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p
Filling the s orbital (max 2 e-'s) gives the metallic s-block elements of Groups 1-2,
filling the p orbitals gives the predominantly non-metallic p block elements of Group 3-7, 0 (Gps 1318) bar aluminium for Period 3.
o Oxidation states in compounds (numerically = valency) are: sodium Na (+1 only), magnesium Mg (+2 only),
aluminium Al (+3 only), Si (+4, -4 with electropositive metals), P (usually -3, +3 or +5), S (-2, +4 and +4), Cl
(-1, +1, +3, +5 and +7), Ar has no stable compounds due to the full outer quantum level (shell) being full,
conferring extra electronic stability on the atom.
From Na to Cl the maximum oxidation state is equal to the 'old' group number and the 'highest' oxide
formulae can be predicted up to chlorine and the chloride formula up to P (there is no stable SCl6
but there is a ClF7.
So in the 'highest' oxides you can go from +1 to +7 for groups 1 to 7/17
(at Xe on Period 5 you can reach +8, but not for Ar)
Na2O, MgO, Al2O3, SiO2, P4O10 (= P2O5), SO3, Cl2O7 (at Xe you can have XeO4)
i.e. using all available 1-7 outer 3s and 3p electrons (valence electrons) are all used in the
bonding of the highest possible oxide.
and similarly in the 'highest' chlorides (upto Group 5), and fluorides (for Groups 6 and 7) you
also go from maximum oxidation state of +1 to +7 in the halide compounds irrespective of
bond character.
NaCl, MgCl2, AlCl3, SiCl4, PCl5, SF6, ClF7 (at Xe you can have XeF8)
o Reaction of element with oxygen and the structure of the oxide
(Gp 6) S(s) + O2(g) ==> SO2(g) and a little SO3 on heating in air
(aq)
The chemical character of the oxides - reaction of the Period 3 oxides with water, acids or alkalis.
o Sodium oxide/peroxide Na2O/Na2O2 and magnesium oxide MgO are basic and form an alkali in water
and salts with acids.
MgO(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MgCl2(aq) + H2O(l)
o Aluminium oxide Al2O3 has no reaction, insoluble, but is amphoteric and forms salts with acids and alkalis.
Al2O3(s) + 6HCl(aq) ==> 2AlCl3(aq) + 3H2O(l)
Al2O3(s) + 2NaOH(aq) + 3H2O(l) ==> 2Na[Al(OH)4](aq)
o Silicon(IV) oxide (silicon dioxide) SiO2 has no reaction but is weakly acidic forming salts with alkalis.
o Phosphorus(III) oxide P4O6 and phosphorus(V) oxide P4O10 are moderately-strong acidic oxides forming
phosphoric(III) acid H3PO3 and phosphoric(V) acid H3PO4 on reaction with water.
Generally speaking, in a series of oxides for the same element, the higher the oxidation state of X in
a 'XxOy' series, the more acidic is the oxide, so H 3PO4 is a stronger acid than H3PO3.
The oxides or acids are readily neutralised to give phosphate salts e.g.
H3PO4 (aq) + NaOH(aq) ==> NaH2PO4(aq) + H2O(l)
Two further reactions are possible with the sodium hydroxide to give Na2HPO4 and Na3PO4.
o Chlorine(I) oxide Cl2O and chlorine(VII) oxide Cl2O7 are moderate to strong acidic in water.
o The overall patterns, from left to right across Period 3 is ...
o giant ionic lattice ==> small covalent molecules
The change in bonding character from ionic to covalent in the oxide follows the decreasing
difference in electronegativity between that of the element and oxygen.
o In terms of overall chemical character ...
metal basic oxides ==> amphoteric oxides ==> non-metal oxides
o This is chemically characteristic of metallic ==> non-metallic element character.
o Reaction of element with chlorine and the structure of the chloride
NaCl (+1), MgCl2 (+2), AlCl3 (+3), SiCl4 (+4), PCl5 (+5), S2Cl2 (+1), Cl2, Ar no chloride
So the number of atoms of chlorine combined with the Period 3 element (the valency) follows the
pattern
1 2 3 4 5 1 1 0
(aq)
2+
(aq)
+
You go from X H ==> X -H ==> X-H ==> X -H
o Radii of isoelectronic ions
Isoelectronic means species having the same total number of electrons.
The table below considers the isoelectronic cations and anions associated with Periods 2, 3 and 4.
isoelectronic
system
Group
4/14
Group
5/15
Period
[Ne] 10e
2
2
6
1s 2s 2p
total nuclear
charge
+6
+7
+8
radius in
picometre (pm)
260
171
140
name of ion
carbide
nitride
Group 1
4-
3-
2-
Group 2
Group
3/13
Period 3
F
2+
Na
Mg
+9
(+10)
+11
+12
+13
136
(38112*)
95
65
50
sodium
Period 3
Al
3+
(Ne)
magnesium aluminium
Period 4
[Ar] 18e
2
2
6
2
6
1s 2s 2p 3s 3p
Si
Cl
(Ar)
nuclear charge
+14
+15
+16
+17
(+18)
+19
+20
+21
radius in
picometre (pm)
271
212
184
181
(71154*)
133
99
81
calcium
scandium
name of ion
Group (Group
7/17
0/18)
Period 2
Period
Group
6/16
4-
3-
2-
Ca
2+
3+
Sc
Excluding the noble gases themselves where this is frankly, something of a data problem!,
o there is a clear pattern of decreasing ionic radius with increase in total nuclear charge (+
atomic/proton number) for the two isoelectronic series tabulated above,
Z = 21 Scandium in 3d-block
The first 3d block element, a typical hard high melting metal whose chemistry is dominated by the formation of the
3+
scandium(III) ion, Sc .
The first of the true transition metals with principal oxidation states of +2, +3 and +4.
White titanium(IV) oxide is an important pigment in the paints industry.
Vanadium is a very typical transition metal, high density and high melting point, various oxidation states (+2 to +5)
and its compounds have catalytic properties.
Chromium is a very typical transition metal, high density and high melting point, various oxidation states (+2, +3 and
+6) and its many complex ions and compounds have a variety of colours.
Manganese is encountered as its oxide, manganese(IV) oxide which catalyses the decomposition of hydrogen
peroxide and the purple ion manganate(VII). Its principal oxidation states are +2 and +7, but+4, +5 and +6 states are
also known.
Iron is a very typical transition metal, high density and high melting point, several important oxidation states (+2 and
+3) and its use in numerous steel alloys.
Cobalt is a very typical transition metal, high density and high melting point, several important oxidation states (+2
and +3) and its use in alloys and forms a variety of complex ions.
Nickel is also very typical transition metal, high density and high melting point, the most important oxidation state is
+2 but +3 complexes are also known and is used in numerous alloys.
Copper is one of the most well known transition metals with two principal oxidation states (+1 and +2) and is
characterised by the familiar and characteristic blue and green colour of copper(II) complex ions or compounds.
Zinc is not a true transition metal but is the last member of the 3d block series. Its chemistry is dominated by the
formation of zinc(II) compounds, its only oxidation state is +2 in compounds.
Gallium is a soft bluish-white metal whose chemistry is a bit like that of aluminium
An important semi-metallic element in the semi-conductor industry for manufacturing computer chips and mobile
phone technology.
Bromine's chemistry is very similar to that of chlorine another of the Halogen elements.
Krypton is very similar to Argon, another of the Noble Gases and has virtually no meaningful chemistry.
o Krypton(II) fluoride and krypton(IV) fluoride have been prepared.
Z symbol
Name
Pauling
electronegativity
Relative
electrical
conductivity
Density
3
g/cm
19
potassium
64
337
774
1047
0.82
419
231
0.143
0.8
20
Ca
calcium
839
1112
1484
1757
1.00
590
197
0.218
1.6
21
Sc
scandium
1541
1814
2836
3109
1.36
631
161
0.015
3.0
22
Ti
titanium
1668
1941
3287
3650
1.54
658
145
0.024
4.5
23
vanadium
1910
2183
3380
3653
1.63
650
132
0.040
6.1
24
Cr
chromium
1857
2130
2672
2945
1.66
653
125
0.078
7.2
25
Mn
manganese 1246
1519
1962
2235
1.55
717
124
0.054
7.4
26
Fe
iron
1538
1811
2861
3134
1.83
759
124
0.100
7.9
27
Co
cobalt
1495
1768
2870
3143
1.88
760
125
0.160
8.9
28
Ni
nickel
1455
1728
2730
3003
1.91
737
125
0.145
8.9
29
Cu
copper
1083
1356
2567
2840
1.90
745
128
0.593
9.0
30
Zn
zinc
420
693
907
1180
1.65
906
133
0.167
7.1
31
Ga
gallium
30
303
2400
2673
1.81
579
122
0.058
5.9
32
Ge
germanium
937
1210
2830
3103
2.01
762
122
<0.001
5.3
33
As
arsenic
2.18
947
121
0.029
5.8
34
Se
selenium
217
490
685
958
2.55
941
117
0.080
4.8
35
Br
bromine
-7
266
59
332
2.96
1140
114
<0.001
3.1
36
Kr
krypton
-157
116
-152
121
3.20
1520
109
<0.001
<0.1
The data is plotted below with explanations and comments (Z = proton/atomic number for the x axis)
Above each period graph is the corresponding periodicity graph for the whole of the periodic table
(g)
+e
The expected general increase in electronegativity from left to right is observed but there two minimums at Mn and Zn.
Again, the 3d block tend to have similar values.
For Period 4, the Group1 Alkali Metal (potassium, lowest Z) has the lowest electronegativity and the Group 7
Halogen & Group 0/18 Noble Gas (bromine & krypton, highest Z's) have the highest electronegativities (there is some
uncertainty in the noble gas electronegativities).
element
1
19K
2
20C
10
11
12
3/13
4/14
5/15
6/16
7/17
21Sc
22Ti
23V
24Cr
25Mn
26Fe
27Co
28Ni
29Cu
30Zn
31Ga
32Ge
33As
34Se
35Br
coppe
r
zinc
gallium
iron
cobalt nickel
germani
arsenic
um
seleniu
bromine
m
electron
[Ar]4s [Ar] [Ar]3d [Ar]3d2 [Ar]3d [Ar]3d [Ar]3d5 [Ar]3d6 [Ar]3d [Ar]3d [Ar]3d [Ar]3d [Ar]3d14 [Ar]3d14 [Ar]3d14 [Ar]3d14 [Ar]3d14
configuratio
1
1
3
5
7
8
10
10
4s2
4s2
4s2
4s2
4s1
4s2
4s2
4s2
4s2
4s1
4s2
s24p1
s24p2
s24p3
s24p4
s24p5
n
ox. states
oxides
+1
+2
K2O,
K2O2 Ca
,
O
KO2
+3
Sc2
O3
+2,
+3,
+4
+2,
+3,
+4,
+5
+2,
+3,
+6
+2,
+4,
+6,
+7
+2,
+3
+2,
+3
+2,
+3
+1,
+2
+2
-2, +2,
+4, +6
-1, +1,
+3,
+5, +7
VO,
MnO,
CrO,
As4O
V2O3
MnO2
Cu2
Br2O,
Cr2O
Fe2O
SeO2,
TiO,
GeO,
6,
,
,
CoO NiO O, ZnO Ga2O3
BrO2,
TiO2
,
GeO2 As4O1 SeO3
3
VO2, 3
Mn2O
CuO
BrO3
CrO3
0
V2O5
7
nature of
oxides
basi
c,
amp
basic ho,
basi bas basi
amp
,
c
ic
c
amp ho,
ho wea
kly
acid
ic
chlorides
Ca ScCl TiCl3,
CrCl MnCl
KCl
VCl3
Cl2
TiCl
3
4
3
2
basi basic
amph
c,
,
basi
weakl both
o,
amp amp amp basi amp c, amp amph
weakl
all
y
weakl
ho, ho, ho?
c
ho basi ho
o
y
acidic
acidic
y
acid acidi
c
acidic
?
acidic
ic
c
CuCl
FeCl2
Se2Cl2
CoC NiCl
,
ZnCl
GeCl2,
,
GaCl3
AsCl3
,
BrCl
l2
CuCl
GeCl4
2
2
FeCl3
SeCl4
2
ionic
ionic,
ion ioni
,
ioni ioni
nature of
ionic ionic
ionic
cova
ionic
ionic ionic
ic
c
cova c
c
chlorides
?
?
lent
lent
Ca
H2
GaH3
ion
nature of
ionic
ic
hydride
cov
hydride
KH
ionic,
coval
coval
ent
ent
both
cov
cov
GeH4
AsH3
H2Se
HBr
coval coval
ent
ent
cov
cov
The patterns across Period 4 are not as clear cut as for periods 2 and 3 - one reason being the interjection of
the 3d block of metals
Metallic or non-metallic character:
o From far left (metallic) to the far right (non-metallic) the non-metallic character increases as the
electronegativity and ionisation energies increase.
o This trend shows up as the electronegativity difference in M-X decreases (M to the left of X)
(i) the ionic bonding of the giant ionic lattice ==> covalent bonding character of small molecules of
the oxides and chlorides
(ii) the oxide changes from basic ==> amphoteric ==> acidic
BUT within the 3d block the patterns are quite complicated and the oxidation state of the metal very
much determines the structural and chemical character of the compound.
Oxidation states
o From potassium (+1) to manganese (+7) the maximum oxidation state is determined by
isoelectronic
system
Group
4/14
Group
5/15
Period
[Ne] 10e
2
2
6
1s 2s 2p
total nuclear
charge
+6
+7
+8
radius in
picometre (pm)
260
171
140
name of ion
carbide
nitride
Group 1
4-
3-
2-
Group 2
Group
3/13
Period 3
F
2+
Na
Mg
+9
(+10)
+11
+12
+13
136
(38112*)
95
65
50
sodium
Period 3
Al
3+
(Ne)
magnesium aluminium
Period 4
[Ar] 18e
2
2
6
2
6
1s 2s 2p 3s 3p
Si
Cl
(Ar)
nuclear charge
+14
+15
+16
+17
(+18)
+19
+20
+21
radius in
picometre (pm)
271
212
184
181
(71154*)
133
99
81
calcium
scandium
name of ion
Group (Group
7/17
0/18)
Period 2
Period
Group
6/16
4-
3-
2-
Ca
2+
3+
Sc
Excluding the noble gases themselves, there is a clear pattern of decreasing ionic radius with increase in
nuclear charge (+ atomic/proton number) for the two isoelectronic series tabulated above.
From left to right the proton/electron ratio is steadily increasing so that the electrons are experiencing an
increasingly greater attractive force of the nucleus, hence the steady decrease in radii for an isoelectronic
series.
* all sorts of values are quoted for noble gas radii e.g. atomic, covalent and ionic, but most don't fit in the pattern
above which is quite clear for all the cations and anions listed.
Electron
configuratio
n
ZElement
3Li
lithium
[He]2s
11Na
M
sodium
[Ne]3s
19K
potassiu M
m
[Ar]4s
37Rb
rubidium
55Cs
caesium
87Fr
francium
Boiling
Point
Atomi
Pauling
c
Relative
chlorid
1st ionisati Densit
ox. oxide
electro- metalli
electric
e
on energy
y
stat formula
negativit
c
al
formula
3
kJ/mol
g/cm
e
e
y
radius
cond'y
e
pm
18 45 134 162
1 4
7
0
0.98
152
513
0.5
0.108
+1
Li2O
LiCl
98
37
115
883
1
6
0.93
186
496
1.0
0.218
+1
Na2O,
Na2O2
NaCl
64
33
104
774
7
7
0.82
231
419
0.8
0.143
+1
K2O,
K2O2,
KO2
KCl
39
31
688 961
2
0.82
244
403
1.5
0.080
+1
Rb2O,
Rb2O2,
RbO2
RbCl
29
30
679 952
2
0.79
265
376
1.9
0.053
+1
Cs2O,
Cs2O2,
CsO2
CsCl
+1
assume
d Fr2O, assume
Fr2O2,
d FrCl
FrO2
[Kr]5s
[Xe]6s
Meltin
g Point
[Rn]7s
30
27
677 950
0
0.70
270
400
2.0
0.014
One of the most consistent sets of data for any group of the periodic table, helped by the fact they are all metals.
The melting/boiling points, electronegativity, 1st ionisation energy and electrical conductivity decrease down the
group.
The atomic radius and density increase down the group.
The formulae are perfectly consistent with what you might expect from the principles of the Periodic Table e.g. the
chlorides, the metal having the only possible oxidation state of +1 (valency 1).
Down the group the peroxide (M2O2) and the 'superoxide' (MO2) become more stable with respect to the expected
oxide formula (M2O).
7 Detailed advanced level chemistry notes s-block Group 1 Alkali Metals
Electron
configurati
on
ZElement
4Be
M
beryllium
[He]2s
Melting
Point
Boiling
Point
1.57
111
900
1.8
0.250
+2
BeO
BeCl2
109 136
0
3
1.31
160
738
1.7
0.224
+2
MgO,
MgO2
MgCl2
649 922
839
1.00
197
590
1.6
0.218
+2
CaO,
CaO2
CaCl2
769
0.95
215
550
2.5
0.043
+2
SrO,
SrO2
SrCl2
729
0.89
215
503
3.6
0.016
+2
BaO,
BaO2
BaCl2
+2
assum
ed
RaO,
RaO2
assum
ed
RaCl2
[Ne]3s
20Ca
M
calcium
[Ar]4s
38Sr
M
strontium
[Kr]5s
56Ba
barium
88Ra
radium
12Mg
magnesiu M
m
Atomi
Pauling
c
Relative
chlorid
1st ionisati Densit
ox. oxide
electro- metalli
electrical
e
on energy
y
stat formula
negativi
c
conductivi
formula
3
kJ/mol
g/cm
e
e
ty
radius
ty
e
pm
[Xe]6s
[Rn]7s
700 973
114 141
0
3
0.89
223
509
5.0
0.010
A reasonably consistent sets of data for a group of the periodic table, helped by the fact they are all metals..
The melting/boiling points, electronegativity, 1st ionisation energy and electrical conductivity decrease down the
group.
The atomic radius and density increase down the group.
There is total consistency in the formulae for the expected oxidation state of +2 (valency 2) for the chloride and
'normal oxide'.
From magnesium onwards they all form a peroxide (MO 2) as well as the 'normal' expected oxide (MO).
Group 3/13
Melting
Point
ZElemen
Electron
configuration
5B
boron
N
M
[He]2s 2p
13Al
alumini M
um
[Ne]3s 3p
Boiling
Atomi
Point Pauling
c
Relative
chlorid
1st ionisat Densi
ox. oxide
electro- metall
electrical
e
ion energy
ty
state formul
negativi
ic
conductiv
formul
3
kJ/mol
g/cm
s
ae
o
ty
radius
ity
ae
C K
pm
2.04
90
(cov)
801
2.3
<0.001
+3
B2O3
BCl3
246 274
7
0
1.61
143
577
2.7
0.382
+3
Al2O3
AlCl3
240 267
31Ga
10
2
1
M [Ar]3d 4s 4p 30 303
gallium
0
3
1.81
153
579
5.9
0.058
+1,
+3
Ga2O3
GaCl3
661 934
49In
indium
81Tl
thallium
208 235
0
3
1.78
163
558
7.3
0.111
+1,
+3
In2O3
InCl3
[Xe]4f 5d 6s
145 173
304 577
2
1
6p
7
0
1.80
170
589
11.9
0.055
+1,
+3
Tl2O3
TlCl3
10
14
10
Apart from the atomic radius and density, the 'patterns' are not very consistent.
The +1 oxidation state does get more stable down the group, but Group 3/13 chemistry is dominated by the +3
oxidation state compounds.
Group 4/14
Melting
Point
Boiling
Point
Electron
configuration
ZElement
6C
carbon
N
M
[He]2s 2p
14Si
silicon
N
M
[Ne]3s 3p
Atomi
c
Pauling covale
Relative
chlorid
1st ionisat Densi
ox. oxide
electro- nt or
electrical
e
ion energy
ty
state formul
negativ metalli
formul
3 conductiv
kJ/mol
g/cm
s
ae
ity
c
ity
ae
radius
pm
2.55
77
(cov)
1086
2.3
0.001
+2,
+4
CO,
CO2
CCl4
1.90
117
(cov)
786
2.3
<0.001
+4
SiO2
SiCl4
32Ge
S
121 283 310
10
2
2
germani
[Ar]3d 4s 4p 937
M
0
0
3
um
2.01
139
(met)
762
5.3
<0.001
+2,
+4
GeO,
GeO2
GeCl2,
GeCl4
227 254
0
3
1.96
158
(met)
709
5.8
0.088
+2,
+4
SnO,
SnO2
SnCl2,
SnCl4
[Xe]4f 5d 6s
174 201
328 601
2
2
6p
0
3
2.33
175
(met)
716
11.4
0.046
+2,
+4
50Sn
tin
10
14
10
82Pb lead M
PbO,
PbCl2,
Pb3O4,
PbCl4
PbO2
Apart from the atomic radius, 1st ionisation energy and density, the 'patterns' are not very consistent.
The +2 oxidation state becomes more stable down the group.
Group 5/15
nitrogen
Boiling
Point
Electron
configuration
ZElement
7N
Meltin
g
Point
N
M
[He]2s 2p
C K
21 63
77
196
0
Atomi
c
Pauling covale
Relative
chlorid
1st ionisat Densi
Ox. oxide
electro- nt or
electrical
e
ion energy
ty
state formul
negativi metalli
formul
3 conductiv
kJ/mol
g/cm
s
ae
ty
c
ity
ae
radius
pm
3.04
75
(cov)
1402
<0.1
<0.001
-3 to
+5
N2O,
NO,
N2O3,
NO2,
NCl3
N2O5
15P
N
phosphor
M
us
33As
arsenic
31
280 553
7
2.19
110
(cov)
1060
1.8
<0.001
+3,
+5
P4O6,
P4O10
PCl3,
PCl5
S
10
2
3 su su
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
sub sub
M
b b
2.18
122
(cov)
947
5.8
0.029
+3,
+5
As4O6,
As4O10
AsCl3
2.05
143
(cov),
161
(met)
834
6.7
0.026
+3,
+5
Sb2O3
SbCl3
2.02
182
(met)
703
9.7
0.009
+3,
+5
Bi2O3
BiCl3
[Ne]3s 3p
44
51Sb
S
10
2
3 63 90 163 190
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
antimony M
1 4
5
8
14
83Bi
bismuth
10
The Pauling electronegativity, atomic radius and 1st ionisation energy all show reasonably consistent trends.
Apart from nitrogen, the oxidation state pattern of +3 and +5 in compounds is quite consistent, though the +5 state
generally becomes less stable with respect to the +3 state.
Group 6/16
ZEleme
nt
8O
N
oxygen M
N
16S
sulphur M
Electron
configuration
[He]2s 2p
[Ne]3s 3p
Meltin
Boiling
g
Point Pauling
Point
electronegativi
ty
o
o
C K C K
21 55 18 90
8
3
11 39 44
718
7 0 5
3.44
73
(cov)
2.58
102
(cov)
1000
2.55
117
(cov),
190
(met)
941
2.10
135
(cov),
210
(met)
869
2.00
167
812
34Se
S
10
2
4 21 49 68
seleniu
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
958
M
7 0 5
m
52Te
S
10
2
4 45 72 99 126
telluriu
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
M
0 3 0
3
m
84Po
14
10
2
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 25 52 96 123
poloniu M
4
6p
4 7 2
5
m
Atomic
covale
Relative
chlorid
nt or 1st ionisati Densit
Ox. oxide
electrical
e
metalli on energy
y
stat formul
conductivi
formul
3
c
kJ/mol
g/cm
e
ae
ty
ae
radius
pm
1314
<0.001
-1, 2
O2
OCl2
2.1
<0.001
-2,
+2,
+4,
+6
SO2,
SO3
S2Cl2,
SCl2,
SCl4
4.8
0.080
+2,
+4,
+6
SeO2,
SeO3
Se2Cl2,
SeCl4
6.2
<0.001
+4,
+6
TeO,
TeO2,
TeO3
TeCl2,
TeCl4
9.3
0.020
+2,
+4,
+6
PoO,
PoO2
PoCl2,
PoCl4
<0.1
Melting points, boiling points, Pauling electronegativity, atomic radius, 1st ionisation energy and density all show
reasonably consistent trends down the group.
Apart from oxygen, the +6 oxidation state becomes less stable with respect to the +2 and +4 oxidation states.
ZEleme
nt
9F
N
fluorin
M
e
[He]2s 2p
17Cl
21 54 18 85
9
8
3.98
64
1681
<0.1
17 - 23
10
2 34 9
1
3.16
99
1251
<0.1
35Br
N
26
33
10
2
5
bromin
[Ar]3d 4s 4p -7
59
M
6
2
e
2.96
114
1140
3.1
N
chlorin
M
e
[Ne]3s 3p
<0.001
-1
<0.001
Cl2
<0.001
BrCl
I2O4,
I2O5,
I2O7
ICl
na
na
2.66
133
1010
4.9
<0.001
-1, +1,
+3, +5,
+7
85At
14
10
2
N [Xe]4f 5d 6s 30 57 33 61
astatin
5
M
6p
2 5 7 0
e
2.20
140
930
7.5
<0.001
-1, +1,
+3, +5,
+7 ???
iodine
FCl
Cl2O,
-1, +1,
ClO2,
+3, +4,
Cl2O6,
+5, +7
Cl2O7
N
10
2
5 11 38 18 45
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
M
4 7 4 7
53I
F2O
All the physical properties show consistent trends down the group.
Apart from fluorine, all the elements exhibit oxidation states of -1, +1, +3, +5 and +7 in their compounds.
ZEleme
nt
N
M
1s
neon
N
M
[He]2s 2p
18Ar
2He
helium
10Ne
27
2
[Ne]3s 3p
26
9
5.50
49
2372
<0.1
<0.001
na
na
24 24 24 27
9
6
4.84
51
2081
<0.1
<0.001
na
na
3.20
94
1520
<0.1
<0.001
na
na
84
87
argon
N
krypton M
36Kr
54Xe
xenon
86Rn
radon
N
M
18
9
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
10
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
14
10
N [Xe]4f 5d 6s
6
M
6p
18
6
11
12
15
15
6
1
7
2
3.20
109
1520
<0.1
<0.001
+2
na
na
XeO3,
XeO4
na
na
na
16
16
11
10
1
8
2
5
2.40
130
1170
<0.1
<0.001
+2,
+4,
+6,
+8
- 20 - 21
71 2 62 1
2.10
136
1037
<0.1
<0.001
All the physical properties show a consistent trend down the group.
1st Ionisation enthalpy of an element: H for the process X(g) ==> X (g) + e
o The 1st ionisation energy decreases down a group as the outer electrons are increasingly less
strongly held.
o As you go down the group from one element down to the next, the outer electron is further and further from
the nucleus because of the extra full shell of electrons due to the change in period. The outer electrons are
also shielded by this extra full shell of negative charge from the effect of the positive nucleus. The effective
nuclear charge can be considered to be equal to the number of outer electrons and this is effectively the
same for all the elements in a group.
o However, it is spread over an increasingly larger 'outer surface', down the group, so steadily reducing the
electric field effect of the positive nucleus attracting the outer negative electrons. Therefore the outer
electron is less and less strongly held by the nucleus and this combination of factors means the outer
+
electron is increasingly more easily lost, (e.g. the M ion more easily formed), and so less energy is needed
remove it.
o The 'diluting effect' of the increasing outer surface area on the strength of the electron attracting electric field
effect, outweighs the increase in atomic/proton number down the group.
Atomic radius of an element
o Can be defined as volume within which 95% of the electron charge exists on a time averaged basis.
o Atomic radius increases down the group as an extra inner shell of electrons is added per period.
o The argument is almost identical to that for ionisation energy above.
o As you go from one period to another an extra full inner shell of electrons is added and the outer electrons
are increasingly further away, increasingly shielded by more filled inner shells and hence less strongly
attracted to the nucleus
o Therefore the volume occupied by the electrons expands as you go down the group.
Ionic radii
o The ionic radius increases down the group as an extra inner shell of electrons is added per period.
+
2+
o For the trend we assume all the ions have the same charge for the same group e.g. Gp1/2 form M /M ions
or Gp7 form X ions and the argument is identical to that for the atomic radius increase.
o The reasons are identical to the argument set out for atomic radius.
Metallic or non-metallic character of an element:
o Elements tend to get more metallic down a group.
o The trend doesn't show up strongly in Gps 1, 2 (both all metals) and 7 Halogens (all non-metals), but in Gp 4
you start with non-metallic carbon at the top and very metallic lead at the bottom.
o The principal reason is the lowering of ionisation energies as you descend the group.
Electronegativity of an element (usually the Pauling scale)
o The power (electric field effect) of an atom to attract electron charge towards it, in the context of the
electrons of a covalent bond linking it to another atom.
o Electronegativity decreases down a group.
The reason are essentially the same as the lowering of the 1st ionisation energy due to increase in
atomic radius and the outer electrons being less strongly held, even in the context of a bonding
situation.
So, in this case, the arguments support the notion that the nucleus has a lesser and lesser effect in
attracting the outer electrons including a pair of bonding electrons.
This weakens the bond and less thermal energy is required effect a change of state melting or
boiling.
Melting points and boiling points of elements:
o Trends can be a bit complicated due to significant structural changes from one element to another in the
same group.
o However for Groups 1 and 2 the general trend is for melting points and boiling points to decrease down the
group.
As the atomic radii increase down the group, the positive nucleus to delocalised distance increases.
This decreases the electrical attractive force between the immobile ions in the metal lattice and the
free mobile delocalised electrons.
o For Groups 7/17 Halogens and Group 0/18 Noble Gases the melting points and boiling points steadily
increase down the group.
o As the molecule gets bigger with more electrons, the Van der Waals forces (transient dipole - induced
dipole) increase in strength so more energy is required to overcome them i.e. a higher thermal energy increased temperature.
Relative electrical conductivity:
o Generally increases as the metallic character increases, which can, as in the case of
Group 5,
Density
o Generally increases as the metallic character increases, which can, as in the case of Group 5,
o However, even if they are all metals (Groups 1& 2) or all non-metals (Groups 7/17 & 0/18) generally
speaking density does increase down a group.
Oxidation states
o In terms of the general principles of the Periodic Table i.e. group similarity, you would expect all the
elements to exhibit the same oxidation states in their compounds, and generally this is true except for
oxygen in Group 6/16 and fluorine in Group 7/17.
o However, down a group you can get a significant change in the relative stabilities of different oxidation
states.
This is can be seen as increasing stability of a lower oxidation state with respect to a higher
oxidation state e.g.
In Group 3/13 the +1 state becomes more stable with respect to the +3 state
In Group 4/14 the +2 state becomes more stable with respect to the +4 state
In Group 4/14 the +2 state becomes more stable with respect to the +4 state
The character of the chlorides
o For Groups 1 and 2 the halides become more ionic as the difference in electronegativity increases and the
steadily decreasing polarising power of the cation as its radius increases down the group.
o Trends become complicated if two different oxidation states are involved.
The character of the oxides
o For Groups 1 and 2 the halides become more ionic as the difference in electronegativity increases and the
steadily decreasing polarising power of the cation as its radius increases down the group.
o Trends become complicated if two different oxidation states are involved.
The acid-base character of oxides:
o More importantly, oxides get more basic or less acidic down a group.
e.g. Group 5/15
At the top of the group the oxides of nitrogen and phosphorus are strongly acidic,
arsenic(III) oxide is weakly acidic,
antimony(III) oxide is amphoteric,
and bismuth(III) oxide at the bottom of the group is basic.
-
Reaction with conc. nitric(V) acid: Be and Al are rendered passive, rest of Group 2 metals readily
form salts.
o Boron and silicon
Atomic radii: B 88 pm, Si 117 pm
Both elements exist as a non-metallic giant covalent 3D lattice.
Both form a weakly acidic oxide.
--However, it should be noted that these diagonal similarities are 'weaker' than their similarities to the other
elements in their respective groups.
7.1. Introduction to Group 1 Alkali Metals and Group 2 Alkaline Earth Metals
The first two vertical columns of the Periodic Table, i.e. Groups 1 and 2, are called the sblock metals,
because they only have 1 or 2 electrons in their outer shell.
These outer electrons are of an sorbital type (s subshell or subquantum level) and the chemistry of the
metals, with their relatively low ionisation energies, is dominated by the loss of these s electrons to form a
cation and also accounts for their generally high chemical reactivity ...
1
+
o the outer s electron loss by the Group 1 Alkali Metals gives the M ion, and,
2
2+
o the outer s electrons lost by the Group 2 Alkaline Earth Metals forms the M ion,
o and in each case the cation has a residual very stable noble gas core of electrons.
The only chemically stable oxidation states are +1 for Group 1 metals and +2 for Group 2 elements, governed
by the relative ease of loss of the outer s electrons and the subsequent very high ionisation energies required to
remove a 2nd (for group 1) or 3rd electron (for group 2) from the inner noble gas core of electrons left (i.e. from the
next principal quantum level or shell).
The relative ease of delocalising the outer 1/2 electrons in the metal lattice makes them good conductors of
heat and electricity (bonding model for metals).
The low ionisation energies and low electronegativity means that when combined with nonmetals, most
compounds of the Group 12 elements tend to be ionic in nature.
Group 1and Group 2 ions are their compounds are important in the natural world of living systems and geology.
o Calcium carbonate and phosphate minerals are important components of skeletons, teeth as well as bone!
o For marine organisms the skeletal remains form sedimentary rocks like limestone and chalk which mainly
consist of calcium carbonate and magnesium carbonate.
o In biochemistry, at the heart of the chlorophyll molecules involved with photosynthesis is magnesium ion
2+
(Mg ).
+
+
o Sodium and potassium ions (Na and K ) are important components of a balanced electrolyte solutions in
living systems and in nerve impulse transmission systems.
Lithium
11Na
Sodium
19K
Potassium
37Rb
Rubidium
55Cs
Caesium
87Fr
Francium
181
98
64
39
29
27
1347
883
774
688
679
677
0.53
0.97
0.86
1.48
1.87
>1.87
melting point/ C
boiling point/ C
density/gcm
3Li
1st IE/kJmol
513
496
419
403
376
400
7298
4562
3051
2632
2420
2100
152
186
231
244
262
270
M ionic radius/pm
78
98
133
149
165
180
electronegativity
0.98
0.93
0.82
0.82
0.79
0.70
electron configuration
2,1
2,8,1
2,8,8,1
2,8,18,8,1
2,8,18,18,8,1
2,8,18,32,18,8,1
electron configuration
[He]2s
2nd IE/kJmol
atomic metallic
radius/pm
+
3.04V
[Ne]3s
[Ar]4s
2.71V
Li
Na yellow
red/crimson
[Rn]7s
[Kr]5s
[Xe]6s
2.92V
2.92V
2.92V
2.92V
K
lilac/purple
Rb red
Cs blue
Fr na
Typical metals in some ways e.g. silvery grey lustrous solids*, very good conductors of heat and electricity,
relatively high boiling points.
o * When freshly cut they are quite shiny, but they rapidly tarnish by reaction with oxygen to form an oxide
layer, which is why they are stored under oil. Ask your teacher to show you the bottle from which we extract
the lumps for doing our demonstrations not a pretty sight if its a bit old!
o The 1st ionisation energies are the lowest of any group of elements, but note the jump up to a very high 2nd
ionisation energy.
Equations for the 1st and 2nd ionization energies.
+
M(g) ==> M (g) + e (very low 1st IE, M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs, Fr)
+
2+
M (g) ==> M (g) + e (much higher 2nd IE)
The very high 2nd ionization energy is due to removing an electron from an electronically
very stable noble gas inner core of electrons.
Untypical in other ways e.g. relatively soft, low density (Li, Na and K float on water before reacting ...), and very
low melting points.
o The reasons for the low melting points, densities and physical hardness lies in looking at the bonding
model for metals.
o The more electrons that can be delocalised and the closer the atoms (actually ions in a metallic lattice) can
approach each other the stronger the bond, thereby raising melting points, densities and tensile strength.
o However, Group 1 metals can only release one electron per atom to contribute towards the pool of bonding
delocalised electrons. Group 2, 3 and transition metals etc. can contribute more electrons for metallic
bonding. This why the Group 2 elements have higher melting points, densities and are harder metals.
o Also, being the first element on a given period, they have the highest relative atomic/ionic radii because you
have the minimum nuclear attractive force on the outer electrons.
Any metal flame colour is due to electronic transitions in the atom or cation.
o Electrons are promoted to higher quantum levels via collisions of the high thermal kinetic energy particles in
the hot flame. When the promoted electron 'relaxes' or 'falls' back to its more stable electronic level, energy
is emitted (this is the basis of an emission spectrum). If the frequency/wavelength/energy of the photons
emitted is in the visible region of the electromagnetic spectrum, a 'flame colour' results e.g. as observed in
fireworks.
The set of quantum levels and associated energies are unique for each atom which means the
quantum level differences varies from atom to atom, therefore the frequency/energy of emitted
photons is different, hence you see different flame colours in the visible region of light from each
Group 1/2 metal each element has a 'finger print' emission spectrum.
The sblock groups 1/2 have the lowest ionisation energies of all the elements in the periodic table,
o
so the high temperature of the flame (>1000 C) means that the kinetic energy of the flame particles
is quite sufficient to promote electrons to a higher quantum level when the metal atoms collide with
other high KE atoms or molecules.
Planck's Equation: E = h, where
E = E2 E1, the energy difference between e.g. the outer s level E1 and a higher level E2,
h = Planck's constant and = frequency of light of the emitted photons.
For more examplesdetails see electronic structure and emission/absorption spectra
notes.
Oxidation state or oxidation number is always +1 in Group 1 Alkali Metal compounds.
Only the single outer selectron is easily lost, the 2nd, and subsequent ionisation energies are far too high
to form chemically stable cations of 2+ etc. i.e. the energy required will not be compensated by ionic bond
formation.
Detailed notes on oxidation state and redox reaction theory.
The stable Group 1 cation has the electron configuration of a noble gas,
2
2
6
1
1
e.g. the sodium atom, Na, is 2,8,1 or 1s 2s 2p 3s or [Ne]3s
+
2
2
6
so the sodium ion, Na , is 2,8 or 1s 2s 2p or [Ne]
PLEASE NOTE that Francium is highly radioactive and therefore difficult and dangerous to study BUT
all its known physical and chemical properties fit in with it being at the foot of Group 1 and other properties
could be inferred from the properties and group trends of Li to Cs.
4Be
Beryllium
12Mg
Magnesium
1278
649
839
769
729
700
2487
1090
1484
1384
1637
1140
1.85
1.74
1.55
2.54
3.51
5.0
900
738
590
550
503
509?
1757
1451
1145
1064
965
979
14848
7733
4910
4210
3600
3300
111
160
197
215
217
223
34
78
106
127
143
152
electronegativity
1.57
1.31
1.00
0.95
0.89
0.89
electron config.
2,2
2,8,2
2,8,8,2
2,8,18,8,2
2,8,18,18,8,2
2,8,18,32,18,8,2
electron config.
[He]2s
[Ne]3s
[Ar]4s
1.97V
2.36V
Be na
Mg na
melting pt./ C
boiling pt./ C
density/ gcm
1st IE/ kJmol
2nd IE/kJmol
3rd IE/kJmol
atomic radius/ pm
M
2+
ionic radius/ pm
2+
20Ca
Calcium
38Sr
Strontium
56Ba
Barium
88Ra
Radium
[Kr]5s
[Xe]6s
[Rn]7s
2.84V
2.89V
2.92V
2.92V
Ca brick
red
Sr crimson
Ba apple
green
Ra na
Very typical metals, silvery grey lustrous solids, relatively high melting and boiling points, good conductors of heat
and electricity.
o The first two ionisation energies are relatively low but there is quite a jump to the 3rd ionisation energy.
Equations for the 1st, 2nd ionization energies.
+
M(g) ==> M (g) + e (very low 1st, M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba, Ra)
+
2+
M (g) ==> M (g) + e (2nd higher IE)
2+
3+
7.4. General Trends down groups 1 & 2 with increasing atomic number and formula patterns
The 1st ionisation energy (IE) or 2nd etc. decrease: (important to link to reactivity trend)
o
o
o
o
because as you go down the group from one element down to the next, on the next period, the atomic radius
gets bigger due to an extra filled electron shell.
The outer electrons are further and further from the nucleus and are also shielded by the extra full electron
shell of negative charge. Therefore the outer electrons are less and less strongly held by the positive
nucleus and so less and less energy is needed to remove them.
Note (probably not needed for exams, but a Q students might raise):
Despite the significant increase in atomic number i.e. positive nuclear charge down the group, this
effect is outweighed by 'shielding effects' of inner full electron shells and also the nuclear charge is
spread over an increasingly larger surface as the atomic radius increases.
The effective nuclear charge is NOT what it seems as given by the atomic
number and is more related to the number of outer electrons and the size of the
atom.
Successive ionisation energies always increase e.g. ... 3rd > 2nd > 1st ...
o because the same nuclear charge is attracting fewer electrons and on average closer to the nucleus.
o The negative electrons are being successively removed from an increasingly more positive ion, so, not
surprisingly, more energy is required.
o BUT note the 2nd IE for Group 1 (e.g. for potassium in the right graph above), and the 3rd IE for Group 2
(e.g. magnesium in the left graph above), show a particularly significant increase in IE compared to the
previous ionisation energy or energies.
o This is due to removing an electron from an electronically highly stable full inner shell and puts an upper limit
on the chemically stable oxidation state.
o These abrupt changes in the successive ionisation energy graphs are clear evidence of principal
quantum levels that the electrons occupy.
o
o
Because from one element to the next, an extra shell of electrons is added, increasing the
electron 'bulk' and the outer electrons are increasingly less strongly held (see above).
o The radii of the adjacent Gp 2 atom is smaller than Gp 1 atom on the same period,
because the nuclear charge has increased by one unit (L to R in PT), but is attracting electrons in the same
shell.
2+
+
o Similarly the radii of a Gp 2 M ion is smaller than the adjacent Gp 1 M ion on the same period, because
the nuclear charge has increased by one unit (L to R in PT), but is attracting the same number of electrons
in the same shells. (see data tables in section 7.2 and section 7.3)
REACTIVITY TREND THEORY relate to atomic radius and ionisation energy
o The metal gets more reactive down the group because ...
o When an alkali metal atom reacts, it loses an electron to form a singly positively charged ion e.g. Na ==>
+
Na + e (in terms of electrons 2.8.1 ==> 2.8 and so forming a stable ion with a noble gas electron
arrangement).
o As you go down the group from one element down to the next the atomic radius gets bigger due to an extra
filled electron shell.
o The outer electron is further and further from the nucleus and is also shielded by the extra full electron shell
of negative charge.
o Therefore the outer electron is less and less strongly held by the positive nucleus.
+
o This combination of factors means the outer electron is more easily lost, the M ion more easily formed, and
so the element is more reactive as you go down the group best seen in the laboratory with their reaction
with water.
o The reactivity argument mainly comes down to increasingly lower ionisation energy down the group and a
similar argument applies to the Gp 2 metals, but two electrons are removed to form the cation.
o The reaction of a group 1/2 metal with oxygen, water or halogens gets more vigorous as you descend the
group.
Generally (but not always), the melting and boiling points fall steadily:
o
o
This is because the ionic radii increase down the group increasing charge separation between the metal
cations of the lattice and the free delocalised electrons.
o This weakens the electrical attractive bonding force and so less thermal KE is needed to weaken the lattice
to the 'collapse point' i.e. melting.
o BUT the situation is not as simple as might be expected, e.g. the metal ions do not always have the same
crystal lattice packing arrangement.
The electronegativity tends to decrease:
o
o
o
The electronegativity values are the lowest of the elements, but there is still a group trend.
They get lower because the effective nuclear attractive force on the outer electron charge decreases down
the group.
o You can explain it along the lines of the decreasing 1st IE argument (above), by merely changing the
last part of the argument from 'easier to lose electron' to 'weaker attraction of electron charge'.
Formula patterns:
o The general formulae are written in the summary tables in two ways
+
2
o The Group 7 halide ion, X , can be fluoride F , chloride Cl , bromide Br and iodide I .
o The ethanoate ion is included as an illustration of carboxylic acid salts (RCOOH acid ==> RCOO in salt).
The oxides, hydroxides and carbonates and hydrogencarbonates are usually white ionic solids and
the Gp1/2 salts listed in the 2nd table are usually white/colourless crystalline ionic solids.
The Group 2 hydrogencarbonates do not exist as stable solids and are only modestly stable in
aqueous solution at room temperature.
All relevant equations showing their formation and reactions are in subsequent sections.
oxide
hydroxide
hydrogencarbonate
carbonate
OH
M2O
+
M OH
MO
2+
M O
HCO3
M2CO3
MHCO3
2+
M (OH )2
M HCO3
MCO3
2+
CO3
(M )2CO3
M(OH)2
2
MOH
(M )2O
M(HCO3)2
2
2+
M CO3
M (HCO3 )2
hydrogencarbonate, HCO3 , H is +1, C is +4, 3 O's at 2, sum of ox. states = +1 and +4 and 6 = 1
= charge on anion
nitrate(V), NO3 , N is +5, 3 O's at 2, sum of ox. states = +5 and 6 = 1 = charge on anion
2
sulphate(VI), SO4 , S is +6, 4 O's at 2, sum of ox. states = +6 and 8 = 2 = charge on anion
halide
nitrate(V)
sulphate(VI)
ethanoate
anion
cation\
NO3
SO4
MX
MNO3
M2SO4
MX
M NO3
MX2
M(NO3)2
2+
M (X )2
2+
CH3COO
M (NO3 )2
CH3COOM
(M )2SO4
CH3COO M
MSO4
2+
(CH3COO)2M
M SO4
(CH3COO )2M
7.5. The reaction of sblock metals and oxygen & their oxide (O ) chemistry
2+
ionically: (M )2O (s) + H2O(l) ==> 2M (aq) + 2OH (aq) (not a redox change)
2
This is an acidbase reaction, the O ion is a strong BronstedLowry base and accepts a
proton from water (acting as the BronstedLowry acid).
o Unfortunately, except for lithium (an anomaly), 'higher' oxides can be formed e.g.
o 2M(s) + O2(g) ==> M2O2(s) [redox change, M (0 to +1), O (0 to 1)]
shows the formation of the yelloworange peroxide by Na, K, Rb and Cs
2
each oxygen is in the 1 oxidation state in the peroxide ion O2
they readily hydrolyse with water forming hydrogen peroxide
M2O2(s) + 2H2O(l) ==> 2MOH(aq) + H2O2(aq) (not a redox change)
o M(s) + O2(g) ==> MO2(s) shows the formation of the 'superoxide' by K, Rb and Cs
oxidation number changes are M from 0 to +1 as expected, but on average each oxygen changes
1
2
The chloride Cl , nitrate NO3 and sulphate SO4 are spectator ions.
o M2O(s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> 2MNO3(aq) + H2O(l) to give the soluble nitrate salt
o M2O(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq) + H2O(l) to give the soluble sulphate salt
o M2O(s) + 2CH3COOH(aq) ==> 2CH3COOM(aq) + H2O(l) to give the soluble ethanoate salt
The reaction of Group 2 metals with oxygen (a redox reaction)
Group 2 metals: 2M(s) + O2(g) ==> 2MO(s) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
o shows the formation of the oxide expected from their position in the periodic table when the element is
heated or burned in air. Oxidation state changes: M from 0 to +2, and oxygen from 0 to 2.
o The oxide, apart from beryllium, is slightly soluble in water forming the alkaline hydroxide, which increases in
strength of basic character down the group.
MO(s) + H2O(l) ==> M(OH)2(s/aq) (not a redox change, M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
2+ 2
ionically: M O (s) + H2O(l) ==> M(OH)2(s/aq)
2+ 2
2+
2
In each case the chloride Cl , nitrate NO3 and sulphate SO4 are spectator ions.
MO(s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> M(NO3)2(aq) + H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the soluble nitrate salt
MO(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> MSO4(aq/s) + H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to form the sulphate salt (soluble => insoluble)
but reaction increasingly slower for calcium oxide ==> barium oxide as the sulphate
becomes less insoluble.
MO(s) + 2CH3COOH(aq) ==> (CH3COO)2M(aq) + H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the ethanoate salt
Beryllium oxide BeO is amphoteric (another Be Gp 2 anomaly) and dissolves in strong bases like
sodium hydroxide.
The equation below shows the formation of a hydroxo beryllate complex ion (not a redox
change).
BeO(s) + 2NaOH(aq) + H2O(l) ==> Na2[Be(OH)4](aq) (beryllate salt)
2+ 2
2
ionically: Be O (s) + 2OH (aq) + H2O(l) ==> [Be(OH)4] (aq)
7.6. Reaction of sblock metals and water & their hydroxide (OH ) chemistry
The oxides and hydroxides are usually white ionic solids.
+
ionically: OH (aq) + H (aq) ==> H2O(l)
an acidbase reaction, same for all four examples in this section
MOH(aq) + HNO3(aq) ==> MNO3(aq) + H2O(l) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
to give the soluble nitrate salt
2MOH(aq) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq) + 2H2O(l) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
to give the soluble sulphate salt
MOH(aq) + CH3COOH(aq) ==> CH3COOM(aq) + H2O(l) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
+
to give the soluble ethanoate salt CH3COO M
* The hydroxide solutions are readily titrated with standardised hydrochloric acid (burette)
using phenolphthalein indicator, the colour change is from pink to
colourless.
e.g. Na ==> Na + e
in terms of electrons 2.8.1 ==> 2.8 and so forming a stable ion with a noble gas electron
arrangement.
o As you go down the group from one element down to the next the atomic radius gets bigger due to an extra
filled electron shell as you go down from one period to the next one.
o This means the outer electron is further and further from the nucleus.
o This also means the outer electron is also shielded by the extra full electron shell of negative charge.
o Due to this shielding the effective nuclear charge on the external electron is ~ +1 (~ proton number
number of noble gas inner core electrons).
o Further more, the effective nuclear charge of ~+1 is acting over a larger 'surface area' as the atomic radius
increases.
o Therefore both of these factors combine to make the outer electron less and less strongly held by the
positive nucleus as the atomic number increases (down the group).
+
o So, the outer electron is more easily lost, and the M ion more easily formed, and so the element is more
reactive as you go down the group best seen in the laboratory with their reaction with water.
o The reactivity argument mainly comes down to increasingly lower ionisation energy down the group (i.e.
ease of ion formation) and a similar argument applies to the Group 2 metals, but two electrons are removed
to form the cation.
o The enthalpy change in forming the hydrated cation from the solid metal does not appear to be as important
here.
At a more advanced and detailed level, this change can be theoretically split into the
enthalpies of (i) atomisation, (ii) ionisation, (iii) hydration of gaseous ion ... (BUT not here!).
o The reactivity trend is also paralleled by the increasingly negative halfcell potential (E M/M+ and E M/M2+)
down groups, 1 and 2 i.e. increasing potential to acts as a reducing agent an electron donor.
o As with water, the reaction of a group 1/2 metal with oxygen or halogens gets more vigorous as you
descend the group.
All the hydroxides are basic with increasing strength down the group and readily neutralised by acids (not redox
reactions). Magnesium hydroxide is sparingly soluble in water but the solubility increases down the group.
o M(OH)2(aq/s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MCl2(aq) + 2H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the soluble chloride salt*
+
all base (OH ) ... acid (H ) reactions
+
ionically if soluble the reaction is: OH (aq) + H (aq) ==> H2O(l)
2+
+
2+
ionically if insoluble: M (OH )2(s) + 2H (aq) ==> M (aq) + 2H2O(l)
o M(OH)2(aq/s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> M(NO3)2(aq) + 2H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the soluble nitrate salt
o M(OH)2(aq/s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq/s) + 2H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the sulphate salt
o M(OH)2(aq/s) + 2CH3COOH(aq) ==> (CH3COO)2M(aq) + 2H2O(l) (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
to give the ethanoate salt
o * Saturated calcium hydroxide solution (limewater) can be titrated with standardised hydrochloric
acid (burette, low molarity) to determine its solubility. You normally use phenolphthalein indicator
and the endpoint colour change is from pink to colourless.
The Group 2 hydroxides, M(OH)2, get more soluble down the group:
o If the hydroxide more or less insoluble (e.g. for Be and Mg), they can be made by adding excess
sodium/potassium hydroxide solution to a solution of a soluble salt of a Group 2 metal e.g. three 'double
decompositions' are shown below ...
(i) calcium chloride + sodium hydroxide ==> sodium chloride + calcium hydroxide
CaCl2(aq) + 2NaOH(aq) ==> 2NaCl(aq) + Ca(OH)2(s)
(ii) magnesium sulphate + potassium hydroxide ==> potassium sulphate + magnesium hydroxide
MgSO4(aq) + 2KOH(aq) ==> K2SO4(aq) + Mg(OH)2(s)
(iii) beryllium nitrate + sodium hydroxide ==> sodium nitrate + beryllium hydroxide
Be(NO3)2(aq) + 2NaOH(aq) ==> 2NaNO3(aq) + Be(OH)2(s)
2+
or ionically: M (aq) + 2OH (aq) ==> M(OH)2(s) for any Group 2 metal M
All the hydroxides are white powders or white gelatinous precipitates.
Beryllium hydroxide is amphoteric (an anomaly in the group), because apart from the reactions above, it
dissolves in strong alkalis like sodium hydroxide to form a hydroxocomplex ion salts called 'beryllates' e.g.
o Be(OH)2(s) + 2NaOH(aq) ==> Na2[Be(OH)4](aq) (not a redox change)
2
o ionically: Be(OH)2(s) + 2OH (aq) ==> [Be(OH)4] (aq) showing formation of a complex ion
For the reaction of Group 1 and 2 hydroxides with carbon dioxide to form the carbonates and hydrogen
carbonates, see section 7.9
Group 1 metals are far too reactive to contemplate adding them to acids in a school laboratory!
Group 2 metals, apart from beryllium (another anomaly), readily react with acids, with increasing vigour
down the group (explanation in section 7.4). A redox reaction to form the soluble chloride salt.
o M(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MCl2(aq) + H2(g) (M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
+
2+
ionically for all four examples: M(s) + 2H (aq) ==> M (aq) + H2(g)
oxidation state changes: one M at (0) and two H's at (+1) ==> one M (+2) and two H's at (0)
the metal is oxidised, electron loss, increase in oxidation state
hydrogen ions are reduced, electron gain, decrease in oxidation state
o M(s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> M(NO3)2(aq) + H2(g)
to form the soluble nitrate salt
Looks ok in principle, and does this with Mg and very dilute nitric acid, but rarely this simple, the
nitrate(V) ion can get reduced to nasty brown nitrogen(IV) oxide gas (nitrogen dioxide, NO 2) and
2+
7.8. The reaction of sblock metals with chlorine & halide (X ) salts
The salts are white or colourless crystalline solids
The solids do not conduct electricity (no mobile ions or electrons) but will conduct and undergo
electrolysis when molten or dissolved in water when ions are free to move to electrodes.
+
The salt products, M (X )2, are similar in properties to the Group 1 M X compounds.
However, beryllium chloride has a polymeric covalent structure, due to the high polarising influence
of beryllium in its +2 oxidation state and the smaller difference in electronegativity between BeCl
compared to chlorine and the other group 1 and 2 metals.
7.9. The properties and chemistry of the carbonates (CO 3 ) & hydrogencarbonates (HCO3 )
The carbonates and hydrogencarbonates are white ionic solids
Group 1 carbonates M 2CO3: Formed on bubbling carbon dioxide into excess hydroxide solution
o 2MOH(aq) + CO2(g) ==> M2CO3(aq) + H2O(l) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
2
o ionic equation: 2OH (aq) + CO2(g) ==> CO3 (aq) + H2O(l)
o The carbonates are white solids, quite soluble in water, and, apart from lithium, thermally stable to redheat.
(see section 7.11)
o Hydrated sodium carbonate, Na2CO3.10H2O, is known as washing soda and is used to soften water by
precipitating magnesium and calcium salts as their less soluble carbonates (see section 7.10).
Group 1 hydrogencarbonates MHCO3: Formed on bubbling excess carbon dioxide into the hydroxide solution
o The reaction above happens first and then:
M2CO3(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) ==> 2MHCO3(aq) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
2
+
o these are base(proton accepting CO3 or HCO3 )acid(H from HCl etc.) reactions giving a salt, water and
carbon dioxide
o In all cases M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs e.g.
o M2CO3(aq) + 2HCl(aq) ==> 2MCl(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the chloride salt*
2
+
ionically for any soluble carbonates: CO3 (aq) + 2H (aq) ==> H2O(l) + CO2(g)
o M2CO3(aq) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> 2MNO3(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the soluble nitrate salt
o M2CO3(aq) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the soluble sulphate salt
o M2CO3(aq) + 2CH3COOH(aq) ==> CH3COOM(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the soluble ethanoate salt
o MHCO3(aq) + HCl(aq) ==> MCl(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the soluble chloride salt
+
ionically for any soluble hydrogencarbonates: HCO3 (aq) + H (aq) ==> H2O(l) + CO2(g)
o MHCO3(aq) + HNO3(aq) ==> MNO3(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the nitrate salt
o 2MHCO3(aq) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq) + 2H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the sulphate salt
o MHCO3(aq) + CH3COOH(aq) ==> CH3COOM(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the ethanoate salt
o * The group 1 carbonates e.g. sodium carbonate can be titrated with standardised hydrochloric acid
using methyl orange indicator (red in acid, yellow in alkali, the end point is a sort of 'pinky orange').
Group 2 carbonates MCO3: formed on bubbling carbon dioxide into the hydroxide solution or 'slurry', but beryllium
carbonate is not stable (another anomaly). Non of them are very soluble.
o M(OH)2(aq) + CO2(g) ==> MCO3(s) + H2O(l) (M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
o When M = Ca, this the reaction of limewater when positively testing for carbon dioxide gas.
o They can also be prepared by a double decomposition precipitation reaction (see section 7.10).
o The carbonates decompose on heating to give the oxide and carbon dioxide and exhibit a clear thermal
stability trend (see section 7.11).
Group 2 hydrogencarbonates M(HCO3)2: formed when excess carbon dioxide is bubbled through a slurry of the
carbonate and they are only stable in solution and their reaction with acids is not important:
o MCO3(s) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
M(HCO3)2(aq) (M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
This the reaction of 'temporary hard water' formation from calcium and magnesium carbonate
minerals like limestone and dolomite. Boiling the solution reverses the reaction, so removing the
metal cations from solution, and referred to as removing 'temporary hardness'.
Group 2 carbonates MCO3 readily neutralised by acids to form salt, water and carbon dioxide:
2
+
o These are BronstedLowry base (proton accepting CO3 )acid (H from HCl etc.) reactions giving a salt,
water and carbon dioxide e.g. for M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba
o MCO3(s) + 2HCl(aq) ==> MCl2(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the chloride salt (M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
2+
2
+
2+
ionically for all four examples: M CO3 (s) + 2H (aq) ==> M (aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
o MCO3(s) + 2HNO3(aq) ==> M(NO3)2(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the nitrate salt
o MCO3(s) + H2SO4(aq) ==> M2SO4(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the sulphate salt
o MCO3(s) + 2CH3COOH(aq) ==> (CH3COO)2M(aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g) to give the ethanoate salt
The thermal decomposition of carbonates and nitrates is covered in detail in section 7.11
All the nitrates, M(NO3)2, are soluble in water. (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
The hydroxides M(OH)2, get more soluble down the group: (M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
o If more or less insoluble, they can be made by adding sodium hydroxide solution to a solution of a soluble
salt of M e.g.
magnesium chloride + sodium hydroxide ==> sodium chloride + magnesium hydroxide
MgCl2(aq) + 2NaOH(aq) ==> 2NaCl(aq) + Mg(OH)2(s)
2+
2+
7.11. Thermal decomposition & stability trends of Group 1 and Group 2 compounds
The cation polarising power increases with increase in charge on the ion or decreasing the radius of
the ion, both of which increase the intensity of the electric field effect.
o The 'polarisability of an anion' is how easily the electron charge clouds are 'distorted' by a
neighbouring cation.
The anion is more easily distorted the larger the anion radius and the higher its charge.
The general 'polarising effect' is shown in the diagram below.
n+
n
o Think of the M cation as the Gp1 or Gp2 cation and the XO3 anion as the nitrate ion or the carbonate ion
(and the think the same way for a hydroxide ion or a sulphate in fact any 'oxyanion').
o
o
o
The electrical field of the cation distorts or polarises the anion, and at the decomposition temperature, a
'residual' oxide ion is attracted to the cation and the rest of the original larger anion is released as a gas or
gases.
Notes:
(i) The residual oxide ion is smaller and less polarisable.
(ii) These reactions eventually become favourable at higher temperature because of the large
increase in the 'systems' entropy when gases formed.
(iii) the smaller oxide ion means the resulting oxide has a higher lattice enthalpy than the carbonate
or nitrate etc. and increases up the group making the decomposition more favourable.
Point (iii) forms the basis of a purely thermodynamic argument to explain the thermal stability
trend and even predict decomposition temperatures (see the end of this section).
o The other group 1 Alkali Metal nitrates [NO3 , nitrate(V)] decompose to form the nitrite [NO2 , nitrate(III)] salt
+
and oxygen gas. Lithium is anomalous due to the particularly high polarising power of the Li ion.
o 2MNO3(s) ==> 2MNO2(s) + O2(g) (M = Na, K, Rb, Cs)
o The nitrites, or nitrate(III)'s, are very thermally stable white solids, soluble in water giving neutral solutions in
water.
Group 2 Nitrates:
o For M = Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba the nitrate decompose to form the metal oxide, nasty brown nitrogen dioxide
[nitrogen(IV) oxide] gas and oxygen gas when strongly heated.
o 2M(NO3)2(s) ==> 2MO(s) + 4NO2(g) + O2(g) (M = Be?, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
o Thermal Tdecomp order Ba(NO3)2 > Sr(NO3)2 > Ca(NO3)2 > Mg(NO3)2 > BeNO3)2
Group 1 and Group 2 hydroxides
o The general thermal decomposition equations are ...
Group 1: 2MOH(s) ==> M2O(s) + H2O(g) (M = Li, Na, K, Rb, Cs)
Group 2: M(OH)2(s) ==> MO(s) + H2O(g) (M = Be?, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba)
The thermal stability trend is just the same as for carbonates, nitrates (and even sulphates) i.e. they
become more stable down the group with increasing atomic number of the metal M.
So for group 1 the Tdecomp sequence is CsOH > RbOH > KOH > NaOH > LiOH
and for group 2 the Tdecomp sequence is Ba(OH)2 > Sr(OH)2 > Ca(OH)2 > Mg(OH)2 >
Be(OH)2
o
Comparing the stabilities of Group 1 and Group 2 compounds:
o Group 1 compounds are more stable than group 2 compounds, particularly when group
adjacent elements on the same period.
+
o The reason being the polarising effect of the group I cation M , is much less than the polarising power of the
2+
smaller and more highly charged group II M ion, particularly when comparing adjacent metals on the same
period.
The group 2 cation is both smaller and more highly charged than the corresponding group 1 cation.
A thermodynamic discussion on the thermal stability of sblock compounds
I'm referring to oxyanion compounds like carbonates, sulfates, hydroxides and sulfates
What ensues is a completely alternative explanation of the thermal stability trends of the oxyanion compounds of
alkali metals and alkaline earth metals without any reference to the relative polarising effect of the cation.
It may seem curious at first sight, but large cations can stabilise large anions in a crystal lattice (and vice versa).
o The decomposition temperatures of thermally unstable compounds containing large anions e.g. carbonates,
increases with cation radius.
o The stabilizing influence of a cation can be explained in terms of trends in lattice enthalpies (lattice
energies).
o The arguments given below are purely in terms of the thermodynamics and explain the Group 2 carbonate
stability trend without reference to the polarising power of the cation (which is the argument required by most
UK GCE A level syllabuses).
An initial discussion of the Group II carbonate stability trend illustrates the points made above.
o A study of the thermal decomposition temperatures of the Group 2 Alkaline Earth carbonates proves most
instructive.
o The general decomposition equation for group II carbonates to give the group II oxide is
MCO3(s) ==> MO(s) + CO2(g)
M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba
Beryllium carbonate is not very stable (can be stabilised in an atmosphere of CO 2) and radium
carbonate would be rather too radioactive to study!
MCO3 and MO are sometimes referred to as the alkalineearth carbonates and alkalineearth
oxides.
Most of the data tabulated below was obtained from 'Inorganic Chemistry' 2nd edition, by Shriver, Atkins and
Langford and the Nuffield Science Book of Data (revised edition 1988) plus internet research for research papers
quoting as upto date values as I could find.
Thermodynamic and decomposition temperature data for Group II carbonates of the periodic table.
the basis for the purely thermodynamic argument for the Group II carbonate thermal stability trend
Decomposition
data
Be
Mg
Ca
Sr
Ba
+48.3
+130.4
+183.8
+218.1
+100.6
+178.3
+234.6
+269.3
+175.0
+160.6
+171.0
+172.1
302, 575
837, 1110
1099, 1372
1292, 1565
~100 C
400 C
900 C
1280 C
1360 C
3180
2987
2720
2615
4443
3960
3489
3248
3011
G (kJ mol )
H (kJ mol )
S (J K
mol )
Tdecomp ( C, K)
theoretical
Typical quoted
decomposition
temperatures
MCO3
LE
MO
LE
(kJ mol )
1
(kJ mol )
LE(MOMCO3)
M
2+
radius in nm
?
2+
Be
= 0.034
780
Mg
2+
= 0.078
502
2+
Ca
= 0.100
528
2+
Sr
= 0.127
396
2+
Ba
= 0.143
G = standard Gibbs free energy change for the thermal decomposition of the carbonate MCO 3 (at 298K, 1
atm)
H = standard enthalpy change for the thermal decomposition of the carbonate MCO 3 (at 298K, 1 atm)
S = standard entropy change for the thermal decomposition of MCO 3 (at 298K, 1 atm)
LE MCO3 = lattice enthalpy/lattice energy of the group 2 carbonate MCO3 (at 298K, 1 atm. pressure)
LE MO = lattice enthalpy/lattice energy of the group 2 oxide MO (at 298K, 1 atm. pressure)
LE(MOMCO3) is the difference between the lattice enthalpies of the group 2 oxide and the corresponding
group 2 carbonate
The decomposition temperature was calculated as follows ...
o (i) From the Gibbs free energy equation
G = H TS
(terms defined above)
The criteria for equilibrium is when G = 0
TS = H , therefore T = H / S
= decomposition temperature (K) to give an equilibrium pressure of 1 atm of carbon dioxide gas
o (ii) From the total entropy change equation
This is if your course doesn't involve free energy, or just an alternative method depending on what
data is given or available.
since S surroundings = H / T i.e. minus the enthalpy change divided by the absolute temperature
then: (H / T) = S system
o
o
The first point to be made is that the endothermic enthalpy of reaction increases down the group.
This is itself a clear indication that the decomposition is becoming much less energetically favourable
down the group and remember the entropy change is almost constant down the group.
o The pivotal point in the argumentexplanation rests on the differences between the lattice enthalpies
(LEs) of the reacting carbonate and the oxide product as you descend the group.
o The difference in their LEs is primarily the reason for the rise in the endothermic enthalpy of reaction
leading to the rising decomposition temperature.
o Down the group the lattice enthalpy of both the carbonate and the oxide decrease because the cation radius
increases.
Lattice enthalpy is a function of two factors (other than the spatial positions of the ions)
(i) the charge on the positive and negative ions attracting each other, both constant in
this case and ...
(ii) the radius of the ions. Here the carbonate ion and the oxide ion radii are constant, but
the cation radius is increasing with atomic number of the group 2 metal. This increase the
nuclear (+) ... () ion distance, reducing the force of attraction and hence reducing the lattice
enthalpy.
o However, generally speaking (3/4 values!), as you go down the group the lattice enthalpy of the oxide
decreases more rapidly than the lattice enthalpy of the carbonate.
o This means the difference between the two enthalpies becomes less and less down the group
making the enthalpy more and more positive/endothermic and resulting in an increasingly higher
temperature to effect the thermal decomposition (to the extent of producing an equilibrium partial
pressure of 1 atmosphere of carbon dioxide gas).
2+
2
2+ 2
Breaking up the M CO3 lattice is endothermic, but the formation of the M O lattice is exothermic
and numerically greater than for MCO3 and particularly the lower the atomic number of the metal
(i.e.) higher up the group).
o Note that, although I do not have the comparable data for beryllium, the quoted lattice energy for beryllium
2+
oxide (BeO) is very high due to the very small beryllium cation Be , and therefore extrapolating up the
group, you would expect beryllium carbonate to have a much lower decomposition temperature.
o
This is usually quoted as ~100 C and completely fits in with both the theoretical thermal stability
trend and the experimental thermal decomposition values quoted in the literaturetextbooks.
Further extension of the ideas looking at other thermal stability trends
o The anhydrous Group 2 sulphates show a similar thermal stability trend to the carbonates...
i.e. for the reaction: MSO4(s) ==> MO(s) + SO3(g)
the Tdecomp is in the order BaSO4 > SrSO4 > CaSO4 > MgSO4
o The effect of the cation radius also shows up when comparing the thermal stability of Group 1
carbonates and Group 2 carbonates.
Comparing the two thermal decomposition reactions ...
2+
+
Because of the greater charge on the Group 2 cation (M ) compared to the Group 1 cation (M ) the
lattice enthalpy of the Group 2 oxide is much greater than for the Group 1 oxide.
So, for the sblock metals on the same period, for Tdecomp the trend is M2CO3 > MCO3
The lattice enthalpies are ...
1
2478 kJ mol for Na2O (1239 kJ per mol Na)
1
and 3960 kJ mol for MgO (3960 kJ per mol Mg)
The very high lattice enthalpy of MgO compared to that the LE for Na2O contributes to a much less
endothermic enthalpy of decomposition for the Group 2 carbonate compared to the Group 1
carbonate and hence a lower decomposition temperature for the MCO 3.
o The stability trend for Group 1 alkali metal carbonates is similar to that of the Group 2 carbonates ...
i.e. for Tdecomp the trend is K2CO3 > Na2CO3 > Li2CO3 etc. ...
... for exactly the same reasons argued above for MCO3 stability.
o Comparing the thermal stability of Group 1 nitrates [nitrate(V)] and Group 2 nitrates [nitrate(V)].
In group 1, only lithium nitrate readily decomposes to the oxide ...
4LiNO3(s) ==> 2Li2O(s) + 2NO2(g) + O2(g)
whereas all the other nitrates initially give the thermally stable nitrite [nitrate(III)] ...
2MNO3(s) ==> 2MNO2(s) + O2(g) (M = Na, K, Rb, Cs)
+
The relatively much smaller size of the lithium cation (Li ) produces a particularly high lattice
enthalpy for lithium oxide compared to the other group 1 oxides, hence the direct formation of the
oxide.
However, due to the much higher MO lattice enthalpies, the oxide is formed directly in each case for
the group 2 nitrates ...
2M(NO3)2(s) ==> 2MO(s) + 4NO2(g) + O2(g) (M = Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba)
and the thermal stability trend will be Ba(NO3)2 > Sr(NO3)2 > Ca(NO3)2 > Mg(NO3)2
as in the case of the group 2 carbonates and sulfates etc.
o
7.12. some examples of the uses of Group 1 and 2 Metals and their Compounds.
MCl & MCl2 The Group 1 and Group 2 chlorides are used as sources of metal extraction by electrolysis.
Na & Mg Sodium and magnesium are then used to extract titanium from its chloride by displacement.
Na Sodium vapour is used in the yelloworange street lamps.
NaCl Sodium chloride 'common salt' is used as a food flavouring and preservative, source of chlorine, hydrogen,
sodium metal and sodium hydroxide via electrolytic processes.
NaHCO3 is used in baking powders heat or a weak organic acid (e.g. citric acid) is used in baking powders to form
carbon dioxide gas to produce the 'rising' action in baking.
Na2CO3 Sodium carbonate is used in the manufacture of glass and the treatment of hard water.
NaOH Sodium hydroxide, an important strong alkali, is used in the manufacture of sodium salts, soaps, detergents,
bleaches, rayon.
KNO3 Potassium nitrate is used in NPK fertilisers.
Mg Magnesium metal is used in the manufacture of alloys, particularly those of aluminium.
Mg(OH)2 Magnesium hydroxide is used in antacid indigestion powders to neutralise excess stomach (hydrochloric)
acid. When magnesium hydroxide mixed with water it is known commercially as 'milk of magnesia' as an antacid
remedy avoiding the use indigestion tablets.
CaCO3 Calcium carbonate (limestone) and calcium oxide (quicklime, from thermal decomposition of limestone in
kiln) are both used in agriculture to reduce the acidity of soil to improve its fertility.
CaCO3 Limestone is used directly as building and road foundation material.
CaCO3 Limestone is heated with clay (aluminium silicates) to make cement.
BaSO4 Barium sulphate is used in medicine for Xray colonoscopy of the bowel ('barium meal'), the dense white
solid shows up clearly as a white or dark shadow and hence the physical topography of the intestines.
and there are lots of other examples if you dig around.
Part 8. The p-block elements: 8.1 Group 3/13 Boron and Aluminium in particular
5B
Boron
13Al
Aluminium
31Ga
Gallium
49In
Indium
81Tl
Thallium
Period
Appearance (RTP)
brown solid
silvery solid
silvery solid
silvery solid
silvery solid
2300
661
30
156
304
3659
2467
2400
2080
1457
2.3
2.7
5.9
7.3
11.9
<0.001
0.382
0.058
0.111
0.055
melting pt./ C
boiling pt./ C
density/gcm
-3
relative electrical
conductivity
-1
801
577
579
558
589
-1
2420
1820
1980
1820
1970
-1
3660
2740
2960
2700
2870
-1
25000
11600
6190
5230
4900
88 (cov)
143
153
163
170
na
na
113
132
145
na
57
62
92
105
na
na
na
-0.13V
-0.34V
Electrode potential
3+
E M(s)/M (aq)
na
-1.66V
-0.53V
-0.34V
+0.72V
Electrode potential
+
3+
E M (aq)/M (aq)
na
na
na
-0.44V
+1.25V
Pauling electronegativity
2.04
1.61
1.81
1.76
1.80
2,3
2,8,3
2,8,18,3
2,8,18,18,3
2,8,18,32,18,3
electron configuration
[He]2s 2p
+3
2nd IE/kJmol
3rd IE/kJmol
4th IE/kJmol
M radius/pm
M
3+
radius/pm
Electrode potential E
+
M(s)/M (aq)
property\Zsymbol, name
5B
Boron
[Ne]3s 3p
+3
13Al
Aluminium
10
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
+1, +3
31Ga
Gallium
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
14
+1, +3
49In
Indium
10
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 6p
+1, +3
81Tl
Thallium
Generally speaking down a p block group the element becomes more metallic, but boron is the only true non-metal,
the rest are basically metals with a some non-metallic chemical character.
Three bond pairs of electrons gives TRIGONAL PLANAR shape. The Q-X-Q bond
o
angle is exactly 120 e.g. for gaseous boron trifluoride BF3 (Q = F, Cl and X = B)
H3N:=>BF3
Boron trifluoride (3 bonding pairs, 6 outer electrons) acts as a lone pair acceptor (Lewis acid) and
ammonia (3 bond pairs) and lone pair which enables it to act as a Lewis base - a an electron pair donor. It donates the
lone pair to the 4th 'vacant' boron orbital to form a sort of 'adduct' compound. Its shape is essentially the same as ethane, a
o
sort of double tetrahedral with H-N-H, N-B-F and F-B-F bond angles of ~109 .
It is often a faint yellow in colour, due to traces of iron forming iron(III) chloride.
Aluminium chloride is a curious substance in its behaviour. The solid, AlCl3, consists of an ionic
3+
o
lattice of Al ions, each surrounded by six Cl ions, BUT on heating, at about 180 C, the thermal
kinetic energy of vibration of the ions in the lattice is sufficient to cause it break down and
sublimation takes place (s ==> g). In doing so the co-ordination number of the aluminium changes
from six to four to form the readily vapourised covalent dimer molecule, Al2Cl6, shown above.
Reaction of element with water:
o None due to protective oxide layer.
Reactions of the hexa-aqua aluminium ion:
o It gives a gelatinous white precipitate with sodium hydroxide or ammonia solution which displays
amphoteric behaviour by dissolving in excess strong alkali (NaOH(aq), NOT NH3(aq)) and acids.
3+
Al (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> Al(OH)3(s)
3+
or [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)3(H2O)3] + 3H2O(l)
The hydroxide readily dissolves in acids to form salts:
+
3+
Al(OH)3(s) + 3H (aq) ==> Al (aq) + 3H2O(l)
+
3+
or more elaborately: [Al(OH)3(H2O)3] + 3H3O (aq)
[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3H2O(l)
Thus showing amphoteric behaviour, since the hydroxide ppt. also dissolves in
excess strong alkali (below).
3+
3 [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 6OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) + 6H2O(l) (from original aqueous ion)
3 or [Al(OH)3(H2O)3](s) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) + 3H2O(l) (from hydroxide ppt.)
3 or more simply Al(OH)3(s) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(OH)6] (aq) (from hydroxide ppt.)
o With aqueous sodium carbonate solution, the hydroxide ppt. is formed, and, because of its acidic
nature, bubbles of carbon dioxide gas are evolved.
3+
22+
2[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + CO3 (aq)
2[Al(H2O)5(OH)] (aq) + H2O(l) + CO2(g)
this process of proton donation continues until the gelatinous ppt. [Al(OH)3(H2O)3](s) is formed, but
will not dissolve in excess of the weak base/alkali.
Sodium carbonate is not a strong enough base-alkali to dissolve the aluminium hydroxide
precipitate.
Metals and hydrogen (from positive ions), form at the negative cathode electrode.
Non-metals (from negative ions), form at the positive anode electrode.
3+
2-
At the negative (-) cathode, reduction occurs (electron gain) when the positive aluminium ions are attracted to
it. They gain three electrons to change to neutral Al atoms.
3+
o Al + 3e ==> Al
At the positive (+) anode, oxidation takes place (electron loss) when the negative oxide ions are attracted to it.
They lose two electrons forming neutral oxygen molecules.
2o 2O ==> O2 + 4e
2o or 2O - 4e ==> O2
Note: Reduction and Oxidation always go together!
The overall electrolytic decomposition is ...
o aluminium oxide => aluminium + oxygen
o 2Al2O3 ==> 4Al + 3O2
o and is a very endothermic process, lots of electrical energy input!
Aluminium can be made more resistant to corrosion by a process called anodising. Iron can be made more useful
by mixing it with other substances to make various types of steel. Many metals can be given a coating of a different
metal to protect them or to improve their appearance.
o Aluminium is a reactive metal but it is resistant to corrosion. This is because aluminium reacts in air to form
a layer of aluminium oxide which then protects the aluminium from further attack.
This is why it appears to be less reactive than its position in the reactivity series of metals would
predict.
o For some uses of aluminium it is desirable to increase artificially the thickness of the protective oxide layer
in a process is called anodising.
This involves removing the oxide layer by treating the aluminium sheet with sodium hydroxide
solution.
The aluminium is then placed in dilute sulphuric acid and is made the positive electrode (anode)
used in the electrolysis of the acid.
Oxygen forms on the surface of the aluminium and reacts with the aluminium metal to form a thicker
protective oxide layer.
Aluminium can be alloyed to make 'Duralumin' by adding copper (and smaller amounts
of magnesium, silicon and iron), to make a stronger alloy used in aircraft components (low density =
'lighter'!), greenhouse and window frames (good anti-corrosion properties), overhead power lines (quite a
good conductor and 'light'), but steel strands are included to make the 'line' stronger and poorly electrical
conducting ceramic materials are used to insulate the wires from the pylons and the ground.
There is a note about structure of metal alloys on the metallic bonding page.
Reactions of aluminium
o Reaction with chlorine
o
o
If dry chlorine gas Cl2 is passed over heated iron or aluminium, the chloride is produced. The experiment
(shown above) should be done very carefully by the teacher in a fume cupboard.
2Al(s) + 3Cl2(g) ==> 2AlCl3(s)
The aluminium can burn intensely with a violet flame, white fumes of aluminium chloride sublime
from the hot reacted aluminium and the white solid forms on the cold surface of the flask (its often
discoloured yellow from the trace chlorides of copper or iron that may be formed).
2Fe(s) + 3Cl2(g) ==> 2FeCl3(s)
Aluminium chloride reacts exothermically as it is hydrolysed by water to give the metal
hydroxide and fumes of hydrogen chloride, and so dry conditions are needed.
Aluminium chloride cannot be made in an anhydrous form from aqueous solution neutralisation. This
is because on evaporation the compounds contain 'water of crystallisation'. On heating the hydrated
salt it hydrolyses and decomposes into water, the oxide or hydroxide and fumes of hydrogen
chloride.
Reaction of chloride with water:
With a little water it rapidly, and exothermically hydrolyses to form
aluminium hydroxide and nasty fumes of hydrogen chloride gas.
AlCl3(s) + 3H2O(l) ==> Al(OH)3(s) + 3HCl(g)
However, if a large excess of water is rapidly added, a weakly acidic solution of aluminium
chloride is formed, with the minimum of nasty fumes!
3+
AlCl3(s) + aq ==> Al (aq) + 3Cl (aq)
3+
or more correctly: AlCl3(s) + 6H2O(l) ==> [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3Cl (aq)
The solution is slightly acidic, because the hexa-aqa aluminium ion can donate a proton to a
water molecule forming the oxonium ion.
3+
2+
+
[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + H2O(l)
[Al(H2O)5OH] (aq) + H3O (aq)
The surface of aluminium goes white when strongly heated in air/oxygen to form white solid aluminium
oxide. Theoretically its quite a reactive metal but an oxide layer is readily formed even at room
temperature and this has quite an inhibiting effect on its reactivity. Even when scratched, the oxide
layer rapidly reforms, which is why it appears to be less reactive than its position in the reactivity series of
metals would predict but the oxide layer is so thin it is transparent, so aluminium surfaces look metallic and
not a white matt surface.
aluminium + oxygen ==> aluminium oxide
4Al(s) + 3O2(g) ==> 2Al2O3(s)
Under 'normal circumstances' in the school laboratory aluminium has virtually no reaction with
water, not even when heated in steam due to a protective aluminium oxide layer of Al2O3. (see
above) The metal chromium behaves chemically in the same way, forming a protective layer of
chromium(III) oxide, Cr2O3, and hence its anti-corrosion properties when used in stainless steels and
chromium plating. Although this again illustrates the 'under-reactivity' of aluminium, the Thermit
Reaction shows its rightful place in the reactivity series of metals.
The Thermit reaction: However the true reactivity of aluminium can be spectacularly seen when its grey
powder is mixed with brown iron(III) oxide powder. When the mixture is ignited with a magnesium fuse
(needed because of the very high activation energy!), it burns very exothermically in a shower of sparks to
leave a red hot blob of molten=>solid iron and white aluminium oxide powder. Note the high temperature
of the magnesium fuse flame is so high, the oxide layer (to the delight of all pupils) fails to inhibit the
displacement reaction! yippee!
aluminium + iron(III) oxide ==> iron + aluminium oxide
aluminium + iron(III) oxide ==> aluminium oxide + iron
2Al(s) + Fe2O3(s) ==> Al2O3(s) + 2Fe(s)
This is a typical displacement reaction by a more reactive metal displacing a less reactive metal
from one of its compounds.
Slow reaction with dilute hydrochloric acid to form the colourless soluble salt aluminium chloride and
hydrogen gas.
aluminium + hydrochloric acid ==> aluminium chloride + hydrogen
2Al(s) + 6HCl(aq) ==> 2AlCl3(aq) + 3H2(g)
The reaction with dilute sulphuric acid is very slow to form colourless aluminium sulphate and
hydrogen.
aluminium + sulphuric acid ==> aluminium sulphate + hydrogen
2Al(s) + 3H2SO4(aq) ==> Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 3H2(g)
If the surface of aluminium is treated with less reactive metal salt, it is still possible to get a displacement
reaction. Check this out by leaving a piece of aluminium foil in copper(II) sulphate solution and a patchy
pink colour of copper metal slowly appears over many hours/days?
aluminium + copper(II) sulphate ==> aluminium sulphate + copper
2Al(s) + 3CuSO4(aq) ==> Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 3Cu(s)
2+
3+
ionic redox equation: 2Al(s) + 3Cu (aq) ==> 2Al (aq) + 3Cu(s)
The addition of limited amounts of the bases sodium hydroxide or ammonia solution to an aluminium salt
solution.
3+
o [Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> [Al(H2O)3(OH)3](s) + 3H2O(aq)
o A white gelatinous precipitate of aluminium hydroxide is formed.
3+
Simplified equation: Al (aq) + 3OH (aq) ==> Al(OH)3(s)
The further addition of excess sodium hydroxide or ammonia solution.
o With excess ammonia there is no effect, but with excess sodium hydroxide the aluminium hydroxide
dissolves to form a soluble aluminate complex anion - therefore exhibiting amphoteric behaviour. since the
hydroxide will also dissolve in acids (paragraph below NaOH equation).
3o [Al(H2O)3(OH)3](s) + 3OH (aq) ==> *[Al(OH)6] (aq) + 3H2O(aq)
(aq)
too. You could write the equation in terms of forming these species too and any of the three
possibilities should get you the marks.
o To complete the 'amphoteric' picture of aluminium hydroxide we consider it dissolving in mineral
acids to form typical salts e.g. aluminium chloride, aluminium nitrate and aluminium sulphate.
Al(OH)3(s) + 3HCl(aq) ==> AlCl3(aq) + 3H2O(l)
Al(OH)3(s) + 3HNO3(aq) ==> Al(NO3)3(aq) + 3H2O(l)
2Al(OH)3(s) + 3H2SO4(aq) ==> Al2(SO4)3(aq) + 6H2O(l)
The addition of sodium carbonate solution to an aluminium salt solution.
o Bubbles of carbon dioxide and a white gelatinous precipitate of aluminium hydroxide are formed.
3+
2 2[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + 3CO3 (aq) ==> 2[Al(H2O)3(OH)3](s) + 3CO2(g) + 3H2O(aq)
There several equation 'permutations' to represent this quite complicated reaction, so I've just
composed one that shows the formation of both observed products. Since sodium carbonate
solution is alkaline you can legitimately write a hydroxide ppt. equation as for sodium hydroxide
above but it doesn't show the formation of carbon dioxide.
You can write an equation to show the formation of carbon dioxide leaving a soluble cationic
complex of aluminium in solution and this equation fits in well with the acid-base nature of
this reaction.
3+
2+
[Al(H2O)6] (aq) + CO3 (aq) ==> 2[Al(H2O)4(OH)2] (aq) + CO2(g) + 3H2O(aq)
This equation shows the hexaaquaaluminium ion acting as a Bronsted-Lowry acid
donating two protons to the carbonate ion (B-L base) to form carbon dioxide and
water.
This reaction shows why 'aluminium carbonate' 'Al2(CO3)3' cannot exist. The hydrated highly
charged central metal ion is too acidic to co-exist with a carbonate ion. The same situation applies to
3+
3+
the chromium(III) Cr and iron(III) Fe ions i.e. no chromium(III) carbonate or iron(III) carbonate
exists. However with a lesser charged, lesser acidic ion, carbonates can exist, so there is an iron(II)
carbonate FeCO3.
o Aluminium salt solutions are slightly acidic for the same reasons as the carbonate reaction - namely the
acidity of the hexaaquaaluminium ion i.e. a acting as a proton donor.
3+
3-
2+
1 2 3 4
From 1 to 7 happen as you add more alkali, increasing pH and the OH concentration, removing protons
from the aluminium complex.
5 6 7 *
From 7 back to1 represents what happens when you add acid, decreasing pH, increasing H /H3O
concentration and protonating the aluminium complex.
Lithium tetrahydridoaluminate(III), LiAlH 4 (lithium tetrahydride) reduces aldehydes to primary alcohols and
ketones to secondary alcohols.
LiAlH4 is a more powerful reducing agent than NaBH4 and reacts violently with water, so the reaction must be
carried out in an inert solvent like ethoxyethane ('ether'). The initial product is hydrolysed by dil. sulphuric acid.
o aldehyde: RCHO + 2[H] ==> RCH2OH (R = H, alkyl or aryl)
o ketone: R2C=O + 2[H] ==> R2CHOH (R = alkyl or aryl)
LiAlH4 is a more powerful reducing agent than NaBH4, and in ether solvent, readily reduces carboxylic acids to
primary alcohols. The reaction can be summarised as:
o RCOOH + 4[H] ==> RCH2OH + H2O (R = H, alkyl or aryl)
LiAlH4 is a more powerful reducing agent than NaBH4 and in ether solvent will reduce nitriles to primary aliphatic
amines.
o RC N + 4[H] ==> RCH2NH2 (R = H, alkyl or aryl)
LiAlH4 is a more powerful reducing agent than NaBH4 and in ether solvent readily reduces nitro-aromatics to
primary aromatic amines.
o C6H5NO2 + 6[H] ==> C6H5NH2 + 2H2O
methylnitrobenzenes would be reduced to methylphenylamine primary amines, i.e.
o CH3C6H4NO2 + 6[H] ==> CH3C6H4NH2 + 2H2O
as will any aromatic compound with a nitro group (-NO2) directly attached to a benzene ring.
Part 8. The p-block elements: 8.2 Group 4/14 carbon & silicon in particular
6C
carbon
14Si
Silicon
32Ge
Germanium
50Sn
Tin
82Pb
Lead
Period
Appearance (RTP)
black amorphous
powder or bluegrey metalloid pure for semiconductors
silvery white
brittle metal
soft silvery
metal
3547 sub
1410
937
232
328
4827 sub
2355
2830
2270
1740
2.3 (graphite)/3.5
(diamond)
2.3
5.3
5.8
11.4
-1
1086
786
762
709
716
-1
2350
1580
1540
1410
1450
-1
4610
3230
3300
2940
3080
4th IE/kJmol
-1
6220
4360
4390
2930
4080
5th IE/kJmol
-1
37800
16000
8950
7780
6700
atomic covalent or
metallic radius/pm
77 (cov)
117 (cov)
139 (met)
158 (met)
175 (met)
170
210
na
190
200
melting pt./ C
boiling pt./ C
density/ gcm
-3
2nd IE/kJmol
3rd IE/kJmol
2+
radius/pm
na
na
90
93
132
4+
radius/pm
na
na
na
74
84
2+
na
na
-0.25V
-0.14V
-0.13V
na
na
0.00V
+0.15V
+1.69V
electronegativity
2.55
1.90
2.01
1.96
2.33
2,4
2,8,4
2,8,18,4
2,8,18,18,4
2,8,18,32,18,3
electron configuration
[He]2s 2p
principal oxidation
states
e.g. -4 CH4, +2
CO, +4 CO2
2+
(aq)/M
(aq)
4+
(aq)
property\Zsymbol,
name
6C
carbon
[Ne]3s 3p
+4, -4
14Si
Silicon
10
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
+2, +4
32Ge
Germanium
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
14
+2, +4
50Sn
Tin
10
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 6p
+2, +4
82Pb
Generally speaking down a p block group the element becomes more metallic in chemical character.
Carbon and silicon are essentially non-metals, germanium is a metalloid.
Tin is basically metallic with a little non-metallic chemical character, lead is a metal.
Lead
In the case of SiCl4, 3d orbitals can be used to accept a lone pair from water, so providing a
mechanistic route for hydrolysis to occur. (compare with silicon).
Reaction of element with water:
o No reaction with cold water but red hot carbon reacts with steam to form carbon monoxide and hydrogen.
C(s) + H2O(g) ==> CO(g) + H2(g)
Other comments:
o All of organic chemistry is based on the compounds of carbon except for the oxides and carbonates.
The structure of the elements carbon and silicon and their oxides
The structure of the three allotropes of carbon (diamond, graphite and fullerenes), silicon
and silicon dioxide (silica)
It is possible for many atoms to link up to form a giant covalent structure or lattice.
The atoms are usually non-metals.
This produces a very strong 3-dimensional covalent bond network or lattice.
This gives them significantly different properties from the small simple covalent
molecules mentioned above.
DIAGRAMS
Carbon-DIAMOND
and silicon
In carbon dioxide, the smaller C atom can form a double bond with oxygen, but in silicon
dioxide (silicon(IV) oxide, silica, quartz) the larger Si atom can only form single Si-O
bonds.
The result is SiO2 has a giant 3D covalent lattice structure or network in which each
silicon atom forms 4 bonds to an oxygen in a 'tetrahedral' spatial arrangement.
The structure is therefore held together by strong covalent bonds (not weak
intermolecular forces) and so it is far more thermally stable giving a high melting point,
and insoluble in any solvent, because solvation energies are much lower than covalent
bond energies.
Carbon and silicon are two elements which form giant covalent structures i.e. they
are high melting and insoluble solids.
Carbon (diamond) and silicon form networks based on tetrahedral arrangements of C-C
or Si-Si bonds around each atom. Both are very hard substances because of the strong
bonding, diamond is harder because the smaller C atoms give shorter stronger bonds.
Both are poor conductors of electricity because the outer electrons are strongly held
and localised between the two atoms of any bond.
However, carbon in the form of graphite, forms hexagonal ring layers in which the
three C-C single bonds are supplemented by delocalised electron bonding from the 4th
out electron of carbon. This makes graphite a moderately good electrical conductor as
the electrons can move freely through a layer. The layers are held together by weak
inter-molecular forces and easily slip over each other making graphite a 'slippery' brittle
solid. But as a giant covalent structure it is still high melting and insoluble.
Relatively recently (and another case of serendipity!) a 3rd form of carbon has been
discovered in the form of the 'ball shaped' fullerenes.
TYPICAL PROPERTIES of GIANT COVALENT STRUCTURES
This type of giant covalent structure is thermally very stable and has a very high melting
and boiling points because of the strong covalent bond network (3D or 2D in the case
of graphite below).
A relatively large amount of energy is needed to melt or boil giant covalent structures.
Energy changes for the physical changes of state of melting and boiling for a range of
differently bonded substances are compared in a section of the Energetics Notes.
They are usually poor conductors of electricity because the electrons are not usually
free to move as they can in metallic structures.
Also because of the strength of the bonding in all directions in the structure, they are
often very hard, strong and will not dissolve in solvents like water. The bonding
network is too strong to allow the atoms to become surrounded by solvent molecules
Silicon dioxide [silicon(IV) oxide, silica, SiO2] has a similar 3D structure and properties
to carbon (diamond) e.g. very hard, very high melting point and virtually insoluble in
anything!
o This contrasts sharply with the structure and properties of the gas carbon
dioxide which is a small covalent molecule.
o With only weak intermolecular forces between the O=C=O molecules it
o
consequently has a very low melting/boiling point (actually it sublimes at -78 C).
Carbon dioxide readily dissolves in solvents such as water and organic polar
solvents.
+
do Carbon dioxide has two polar bonds, C =O , but because of the linearity of the
molecule the two permanent dipoles cancel out to give overall a non-polar
molecule
o Note that carbon + oxygen, instead of forming a 3D network of O-C-O single
bonds, with the smaller carbon atom, it is energetically more favourable to form
C=O double bonds and thus forming a small triatomic molecule.
The hardness of diamond enables it to be used as the 'leading edge' on cutting
tools.
Energy changes for the physical changes of state of melting and boiling for a range of
differently bonded substances is given in a section of the Energetics Notes.
Many naturally occurring minerals are based on -O-X-O- linked 3D structures
where X is often silicon (Si) and aluminium (Al), three of the most abundant
elements in the earth's crust.
o Silicon dioxide is found as quartz in granite (igneous rock) and is the main
component in sandstone - which is a sedimentary rock formed the compressed
erosion products of igneous rocks.
o Many some minerals that are hard wearing, rare and attractive when polished,
hold great value as gemstones.
Carbon also occurs in the form of graphite. The carbon atoms form joined hexagonal
rings forming layers 1 atom thick.
There are three strong covalent bonds per carbon (3 C-C bonds in a planar
SILICA
silicon dioxide
GRAPHITE
arrangement from 3 of its 4 outer electrons), BUT, the fourth outer electron is
'delocalised' or shared between the carbon atoms to form the equivalent of a 4th bond
per carbon atom (this situation requires advanced level concepts to fully explain, and this
bonding situation also occurs in fullerenes described below, and in aromatic compounds
you deal with at advanced level).
The layers are only held together by weak intermolecular forces shown by the
dotted lines NOT by strong covalent bonds.
Like diamond and silica (above) the large molecules of the layer ensure graphite has
typically very high melting point because of the strong 2D bonding network (note:
NOT 3D network)..
Graphite will not dissolve in solvents because of the strong bonding
BUT there are two crucial differences compared to diamond ...
o Electrons, from the 'shared bond', can move freely through each layer, so
graphite is a conductor like a metal (diamond is an electrical insulator and a
poor heat conductor). Graphite is used in electrical contacts e.g. electrodes in
electrolysis.
o The weak forces enable the layers to slip over each other so where as
diamond is hard material graphite is a 'soft' crystal, it feels slippery. Graphite
is used as a lubricant.
These two different characteristics described above are put to a common use with the
electrical contacts in electric motors and dynamos. These contacts (called brushes) are
made of graphite sprung onto the spinning brass contacts of the armature. The graphite
brushes provide good electrical contact and are self-lubricating as the carbon layers slide
over each other.
A 3rd form of carbon are fullerenes or 'bucky balls'! It consists of hexagonal rings like
graphite and alternating pentagonal rings to allow curvature of the surface.
Buckminster Fullerene C60 is shown and the bonds form a pattern like a soccer ball.
Others are oval shaped like a rugby ball. It is a black solid insoluble in water.
They are NOT considered giant covalent structures and are classed as simple
molecules. They do dissolve in organic solvents giving coloured solutions (e.g. deep red
in petrol hydrocarbons, and although solid, their melting points are not that high.
They are mentioned here to illustrate the different forms of carbon AND they can be
made into continuous tubes to form very strong fibres of 'pipe like' molecules called
'nanotubes'. These 'molecular size' particles behave quite differently to a bulk carbon
material like graphite.
Uses of Nanotubes:
o They can be used as semiconductors in electrical circuits.
o They act as a component of industrial catalysts for certain reactions whose
economic efficiency is of great importance (time = money in business!).
The catalyst can be attached to the nanotubes which have a huge
surface are per mass of catalyst 'bed'.
They large surface combined with the catalyst ensure two rates of
reaction factors work in harmony to increase the speed of the industrial
reaction.
o Nanotube fibres are very strong and so they are used in 'composite materials'
e.g. reinforcing graphite in carbon fibre tennis rackets.
o Nanotubes can 'cage' other molecules and can be used as a means of
delivering drugs in controlled way to the body.
FULLERENES
Hard high melting solid; mpt 1410 C; bpt 2355 C; poor conductor of heat/electricity, but with other elements
added, conducts better, hence use in microchips.
Group, electron configuration (and oxidation states):
2
2
6
2
2
o Gp4; e.c. 2,8,4 or 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p ; (+4 only) e.g. SiO2 and SiCl4 etc.
Reaction of element with oxygen:
o Reacts when strongly heated in air to form silicon dioxide (silica, silicon(IV) oxide).
Si(s) + O2(g) ==> SiO2(g)
Reaction of oxide with water:
o None and insoluble.
Reaction of oxide with acids:
o None, only acidic in nature.
Reaction of oxide with bases/alkalis:
o It is a weakly acidic oxide dissolving very slowly in hot concentrated sodium hydroxide solution to form
sodium silicate.
o SiO2(s) + 2NaOH(aq) ==> Na2SiO3(aq) + H2O(l)
2o or simplified ionic equation: SiO2(s) + 2OH (aq) ==> SiO3 (aq) + H2O(l)
Reaction of element with chlorine:
o On heating in chlorine forms the covalent liquid silicon tetrachloride.
Si(s) + 2Cl2(g) ==> SiCl4(l)
Reaction of chloride with water:
o Hydrolyses to form gelatinous hydrated silicon oxide and hydrochloric acid.
SiCl4(l) + 2H2O(l) ==> SiO2(s) + 4HCl(aq)
Reaction of element with water:
o None
Shapes and bond angles of some molecules and ions of carbon and silicon
With 4 bond pairs of bonding electrons and no lone pairs you get a TETRAHEDRAL shape: e.g. methane CH 4,
o
+
silicon hydride SiH4 with H-X-H bond angle of 109 and similarly ions like the ammonium ion NH4 . Note: No lone
pair, no extra repulsion, no reduction in angle, therefore perfect tetrahedral angle (Q = H, X = C, Si, Ge etc. in group
4)
Similarly with 4 bond pairs, again a TETRAHEDRAL shape: e.g. tetrachloromethane CCl4 or SiCl4 with exact Cl-C-Cl
o
and Cl-Si-Cl bond angles of 109
2-
Carbonate ion, CO3 is trigonal planar in shape with a O-C-O bond angle of 120 because of three groups of
bonding electrons and no lone pairs of electrons.
The shape is deduced below using dot and cross diagrams and VSEPR theory and illustrated below.
Semi-metals or 'metalloids'
Gp Gp Gp Gp
3/13 4/14 5/15 6/16
Al
Si
Ga Ge
As
BASIC IDEA: A narrow diagonal band of elements can show both metallic and nonmetallic physical or chemical properties and are referred to as 'semi-metals' or
'metalloids'. Although most tend to be nearer being a metal or a non-metal, they do
represent the point elements change from metal to non-metal as you move from left to
right across the Periodic Table BUT please read the notes below carefully!
To me boron, B, is clearly a non-metal, showing no real metallic character and I'm not sure
why it is sometimes shown as a semi-metal on some periodic tables? and is very different in
character to metallic aluminium below it in the same group. Boron's oxide is acidic only, and the
solid element consists of a non-conducting giant covalent structure, both classic non-metallic
properties. Carbon, C, is also clearly a non-metal, its oxide is acidic and in the form of
diamond, it is a non-electrical conducting 3D giant covalent structure. However, in the form of
graphite, it has a layered 2D giant covalent structure that does allow electricity to conduct
through the layers.
Physically and chemically aluminium, Al, is very much a metal, but the oxide/hydroxide reacts
with both acids (metallic) and alkalis (acidic) to form salts showing dual character. Silicon is
mainly non-metallic character e.g. the oxide is acidic but, although the solid element has a
giant covalent structure, it shows slight electrical conducting properties (semi-conductor),
especially when doped with other elements and used in computer chip technology. To me,
neither are true semi-metals.
Se
exists in two allotropic* crystalline forms. One form is less dense, non-conducting and covalent
in structure (non-metal) and the other is more dense and weakly electrical conducting (metallic)
and used in transistors. Selenium, Se, is also a semi-conductor with metallic and non-metallic
properties and is used in photo-electric cells (solar cells) and xerography (photocopying).
(*Allotropes are different physical forms of the same element in the same physical state.)
In
Sn
Sb
Te
Arsenic, As, (like antimony in the same group), is also a true semi-metal (metalloid) with
oxides/hydroxides that react both with acids/ and alkalis to form salts and the element exists in
two allotropic* crystalline forms (non-metallic and metallic). Tellurium, Te, is also a semiconductor with metallic and non-metallic properties. Both As and Te are used in electronic
devices.
7N
Nitrogen
15P
Phosphorus
33As
Arsenic
51Sb
Antimony
83Bi
Bismuth
Period
Appearance (RTP)
colourless
gas
white/red solid
allotropes
grey solid
(also
yellow/black
allotropes)
grey metalloid
solid (also yellow
allotrope)
silver-white brittle
metal
-210
44
sublimes
631
272
boiling pt./ C
-1.96
280
616?
1635
1560
-3
<0.1
1.8
5.8
6.7
9.7
-1
1402
1060
947
834
703
75 (cov)
110 (cov)
122 (cov)
182 (met)
X ion radius/pm
171
212
na
na
na
electronegativity
3.04
2.19
2.18
2.05
2.02
2,5
2,8,5
2,8,8,5
2,8,18,18,5
2,8,18,32,18,5
electron configuration
[He]2s 2p
melting pt./ C
density/gcm
[Ne]3s 3p
10
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
14
10
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 6p
-3 to +5
7N
Nitrogen
-3, +3, +5
15P
Phosphorus
+3, +5
33As
Arsenic
+3, +5
51Sb
Antimony
+3, (+5)
83Bi
Bismuth
Generally speaking down a p block group the element becomes more metallic in chemical character.
Nitrogen and phosphorus are non-metals, arsenic and antimony are semi-metals, bismuth
is a true metal.
electrons: three bond pairs and one lone pair, PYRAMIDAL or TRIGONAL PYRAMID shape: e.g. ammonia NH3 with
o
o
bond angle of approximately 109 . Note: the exact H-N-H angle is 107 due to the extra repulsion of one lone pair
(for H-X-H angles: NH3 > H2O and < CH4).
electrons: three bond pairs and one lone pair, PYRAMIDAL or TRIGONAL PYRAMID shape. e.g. nitrogen
trifluoride/trichloride, NCl3, or phosphorus(III) fluoride/chloride (phosphorus trifluoride/trichloride), PF3/PCl3, with bond
o
+
angles Q-X-Q of approximately 109 and similarly with ions like the oxonium ion H3O (Q = F, Cl etc. X = N, P etc.)
electrons: 5 bond pairs, TRIGONAL BIPYRAMID shape: e.g. phosphorus(V) fluoride (phosphorus pentafluoride) PF5,
o
o
o
gaseous phosphorus(V) chloride, PCl5, with bond angles 90 and 180 based on the vertical Q-X-Q bond and 120
based on the central trigonal planar arrangement. Note that solid PCl5 has an ionic structure and is not a trigonal
+
bipyramid molecule - a tetrahedral [PCl4] ion and an octahedral [PCl6] ion.
H3N:=>BF3 Boron trifluoride (3 bonding pairs, 6 outer electrons) acts as a lone pair acceptor (Lewis acid) and
ammonia (3 bond pairs) and lone pair which enables it to act as a Lewis base - a an electron pair donor. It donates the
lone pair to the 4th 'vacant' boron orbital to form a sort of 'adduct' compound. Its shape is essentially the same as ethane, a
o
sort of double tetrahedral with H-N-H, N-B-F and F-B-F bond angles of ~109 .
Ammonia can act as an electron pair donor ligand in transition metal ion complexes
e.g. tetraamminedichlorochromium(III) complex ion - cis/trans isomers (Z/E isomers)
With excess aqueous ammonia a pale blue hexa-ammine complex is formed with hexaaquanickel(II) ions
[Ni(H2O)6]
2+
(aq)
+ 6NH3(aq)
[Ni(NH3)6]
2+
(aq)
+ 6H2O(l)
and also excess aqueous ammonia a pale blue hexa-ammine complex is formed with aqueous copper(II) ions
[Cu(H2O)6]
2+
(aq)
or [Cu(H2O)4]
+ 4NH3(aq)
2+
(aq)
+ 4NH3(aq)
[Cu(NH3)4(H2O)2]
[Cu(NH3)4]
2+
2+
(aq)
(aq)
+ 4H2O(l)
+ 4H2O(l)
Ammonia gas is synthesised in the chemical industry by reacting nitrogen gas with hydrogen gas in what is
known as the Haber-Bosch Process, named after two highly inventive and subsequently famous chemists.
The nitrogen is obtained from liquified air (80% N2). Air is cooled and compressed under high pressure to form
liquid air (liquefaction). The liquid air is fractionally distilled at low temperature to separate oxygen (used in welding,
hospitals etc.), nitrogen (for making ammonia), Noble Gases e.g. argon for light bulbs, helium for balloons).
The hydrogen is made by reacting methane (natural gas) and water or from cracking hydrocarbons (both
reactions are done at high temperature with a catalyst).
o CH4 + H2O ==> 3H2 + CO
o e.g. C8H18 ==> C8H16 + H2
The synthesis equation for this reversible reaction is ...
o N2(g) + 3H2(g)
2NH3(g)
.. which means an equilibrium will form, so there is no chance of 100% yield even if you use, as you actually do,
the theoretical reactant ratio of nitrogen : hydrogen of 1 : 3
In forming ammonia 92kJ of heat energy is given out (i.e. exothermic, 46kJ of heat released per mole of ammonia
formed).
Four moles of 'reactant' gas form two moles of 'product' gas, so there is net decrease in gas molecules on forming
ammonia.
So applying the Le Chatelier equilibrium rules, the formation of ammonia is favoured by ...
o (a) Using high pressure because you are going from 4 to 2 gas molecules (the high pressure also speeds
up the reaction because it effectively increases the concentration of the gas molecules), but higher pressure
means more dangerous and more costly engineering.
o (b) Carrying out the reaction at a low temperature, because it is an exothermic reaction favoured by low
temperature, but this may produce too slow a rate of reaction,
o So, the idea is to use a set of optimum conditions to get the most efficient yield of ammonia and this
involves getting a low % yield (e.g. 8% conversion) but fast. Described below are the conditions to give
the most economic production of ammonia.
o these arguments make the point that the yield* of an equilibrium reaction depends on the conditions
used.
* The word 'yield' means how much product you get compared to the theoretical maximum
possible if the reaction goes 100%.
For more on chemical economics see Extra Industrial Chemistry page.
In industry pressures of 200 - 300 times normal atmospheric pressure are used in line with the theory.
Theoretically a low temperature would give a high yield of ammonia BUT ...
o Nitrogen is very stable molecule and not very reactive i.e. chemically inert, so the rate of reaction is too
slow at low temperatures.
o
o To speed up the reaction an iron catalyst is used as well as a higher temperature (e.g. 400-450 C).
o The higher temperature is an economic compromise, i.e. it is more economic to get a low yield fast, than a
high yield slowly!
o Note: a catalyst does NOT affect the yield of a reaction, i.e. the equilibrium position BUT you do get
there faster!
At the end of the process, when the gases emerge from the iron catalyst reaction chamber, the gas mixture
is cooled under high pressure, when only the ammonia liquefies and is so can be removed and stored in
cylinders.
Any unreacted nitrogen or hydrogen (NOT liquified), is recycled back through the reactor chamber, nothing
o
o
o
is wasted! [nitrogen (-196 C) and hydrogen (-252 C) have much lower boiling points than ammonia (-33 C). Boiling
points increase with pressure, but these normal atmospheric pressure values offer a fair comparison].
To sum up: A low % yield of ammonia is produced quickly at moderate temperatures and pressure, and is
more economic than getting a higher % equilibrium yield of ammonia at a more costly high pressure and a
slower lower temperature reaction.
AND there are some more general notes on Chemical Economics on the Industrial Chemistry page.
Ammonia is oxidised with oxygen from air using a hot platinum catalyst to form nitrogen monoxide and water.
4NH3(g) + 5O2(g) ==> 4NO(g) + 6H2O(g)
The gas is cooled and reacted with more oxygen to form nitrogen dioxide.
2NO(g) + O2(g) ==> 2NO2(g)
This is reacted with more oxygen and water to form nitric acid.
4NO2(g)+ O2(g) + 2H2O(l) ==> 4HNO3(aq)
Nitric acid is used to make nitro-aromatic compounds from which dyes are made.
It is also used in the manufacture of artificial nitrogenous fertilisers (like ammonium nitrate, see below).
Ammonia is used to manufacture 'artificial' nitrogenous fertilisers
Overuse of ammonia fertilisers on fields can cause major environmental problems as well as being uneconomic.
Ammonium salts are water soluble and get washed into the groundwater, rivers and streams by rain
contaminating them with ammonium ions and nitrate ions.
This contamination causes several problems.
Excess fertilisers in streams and rivers cause eutrophication.
o Overuse of fertilisers results in appreciable amounts of them dissolving in rain water.
o This increases levels of nitrate or phosphate in rivers and lakes.
o This causes 'algal bloom' i.e. too much rapid growth of water plants on the surface where the sunlight is the
strongest.
o This prevents light from reaching plants lower in the water.
o These lower plants decay and the active aerobic bacteria use up any dissolved oxygen.
o This means any microorganisms or higher life forms relying on oxygen cannot respire.
o All the eco-cycles are affected and fish and other respiring aquatic animals die.
o The river or stream becomes 'dead' below the surface as all the food webs are disrupted.
Nitrates are potentially carcinogenic (cancer or tumour forming).
o The presence in drinking water is a health hazard.
o Rivers and lakes can be used as initial sources for domestic water supply.
o You cannot easily remove the nitrate from the water, it costs too much!
o So levels of nitrate are carefully monitored in our water supply.
Cost - The hydrogen for the Haber Process for manufacturing ammonia is usually obtained from hydrocarbon
sources e.g. methane gas. Therefore, as oil becomes more scarce, the cost of producing 'artificial' fertilisers will
increase.
Nitrogen is an extremely important element for all plant or animal life! It is found in important molecules such
as amino acids, which are combined to form proteins. Protein is used everywhere in living organisms from muscle
structure in animals to enzymes in plants/animals.
Nitrogen from the atmosphere:
o Nitrifying bacteria, e.g. in the root nodules of certain plants like peas/beans (the legumes), can directly
convert atmospheric nitrogen into nitrogen compounds in plants e.g. nitrogen => ammonia => nitrates
which plants can absorb.
However, most plants can't do this conversion from nitrogen => ammonia, though they can all
absorb nitrates, so the 'conversion' or 'fixing' ability might be introduced into other plant species by
genetic engineering.
o The nitrogen from air is converted into ammonia in the chemical industry, and from this artificial fertilisers
are manufactured to add to nutrient deficient soils. However, some of the fertiliser is washed out of the soil
and can cause pollution.
o The energy of lightning causes nitrogen and oxygen to combine and form nitrogen oxides which dissolve in
rain that falls on the soil adding to its nitrogen content.
1. N2(g) + O2(g) ==> 2NO(g), then
2. then 2NO(g) + O2(g) ==> 2NO2(g)
3. NO2(g) + water ==> nitrates(aq) in rain/soil
4. Incidentally, reactions 1. and 2. can also happen in a car engine, and NO2 is acidic and adds to the
polluting acidity of rain as well as providing nutrients for plants!
Nitrogen recycling apart from the atmosphere:
o Nitrogen compounds, e.g. protein formed in plants or animals, are consumed by animals higher up the food
chain and then bacterial and fungal decomposers break down animal waste and dead plants/animals to
release nitrogen nutrient compounds into the soil (e.g. in manure/compost) which can then be re-taken up
by plants.
Nitrogen returned to the atmosphere:
o However, denitrifying bacteria will break down proteins completely and release nitrogen gas into the
atmosphere.
The equilibria between oxygen O2, nitrogen (II) oxide NO, nitrogen(IV) oxide NO2 and its dimer N2O4.
NO2 can be made from the irreversible thermal decomposition of lead(II) nitrate in a pyrex boiling tube connected
3
to a 100 cm gas syringe in a fume cupboard.
o lead(II) nitrate ==> lead(II) oxide + nitrogen(IV) oxide + oxygen
o 2Pb(NO3)2(s) ==> 2PbO(s) + 4NO2(g) + O2(g)
-1
(a) 2NO2(g, brown)
2NO(g, colourless) + O2(g, colourless) (H = +113 kJ mol )
o
o (a) The temperature effect can be observed by strongly heating the gases in the pyrex tube above 400 C.
-1
(b) 2NO2(g, brown)
N2O4(g, colourless) (H = -58 kJ mol )
o
o (b) The temperature effect can be observed by cooling and warming below 100 C.
o (b) The pressure effect can be observed by sealing the cool gases in the gas syringe and compressing and
decompressing it.
Temperature and energy change (H)
o (a) Increases in temperature favours the endothermic decomposition of NO 2 to NO and O2, so at high
temperatures the brown colour fades.
o (b) Decrease in temperature favours the exothermic formation of the dimer N 2O4 from NO2, so the brown
colour fades on cooling the gas mixture.
Gas pressure change (V)
o (a) Increase in pressure favours the LHS, more NO2, because 2 mol gas <== 3 mol gas, so theoretically the
mixture would get darker.
(b) Increase in pressure favours N2O4 formation from NO2, 2 mol gas ==> 1 mol gas, so the mixture would
get lighter in colour.
(b) This can be demonstrated by compressing/decompressing the gas mixture in the syringe to see
the brown colour intensity increase/decrease.
In fact you can even see the dynamic equilibrium 'kinetics' in operation here. There is a time lag of
about 1-2 seconds before the new equilibrium position is established as the 'imposed' colour
intensity change becomes constant.
Concentration change
o (a) Theoretically an increase in O2 would lead to decrease in NO and increase in NO 2, so the mixture would
get darker.
o (b) Increase in NO2 would increase N2O4, but overall the colour would still be darker because not all of the
'extra' NO2 can be converted to maintain the equilibrium.
The formation of nitrogen(II) oxide at high temperature e.g. in a car engine
-1
o N2(g) + O2(g)
2NO(g) (H = +181 kJ mol )
o Temperature and energy change (H)
Increase in temperature favours the endothermic formation of NO.
This reaction does not happen at room temperature but is formed at the high temperatures in car
engines.
Unfortunately when released through the car exhaust, it cools to normal temperatures when NO
irreversibly reacts with oxygen in air to form nitrogen(IV) oxide, NO 2,
2NO(g) + O2(g) ==> 2NO2(g)
Nitrogen dioxide is acidic, a lung irritant and a reactive free radical molecule involved in the
chemistry of photochemical smog not good!
o Its concentration in car exhaust gases can be reduced, along with that of carbon monoxide, by using a
catalytic converter.
o Using platinum, and other transition metal, based catalysts, the following reaction can be made to take place
producing harmless nitrogen and carbon dioxide.
2NO(g) + 2CO(g) ==> N2(g) + 2CO2(g)
Kb =
If you place a piece of magnesium ribbon or a zinc granule in ammonium chloride or ammonium sulphate
solution you will see fizzing as hydrogen gas is formed.
+
2+
2H3O (aq) + M(s) ==> M (aq) + H2O(l) + H2(g)
M = zinc or magnesium
Buffering action ammonium salts
o A mixture of a weak base and the salt of the weak base with a strong acid.
+ o e.g. ammonia NH3 and ammonium chloride NH4 Cl
+
o NH4 and NH3 constitute a conjugate acid-base pair.
o In solution most of the ammonia is NOT ionised (and even suppressed by the ammonium ions from the salt).
It is the weak base that 'removes' most of any added hydrogen ions.
+
NH3(aq) + H (aq)
NH4 (aq)
The salt is fully ionised in solution giving relatively high concentrations of the ammonium ion.
It is the ammonium ion that removes most of any added hydroxide ions.
NH4
(aq)
+ OH (aq)
NH3(aq) + H2O(l)
On heating strongly above 340 C, the white solid ammonium chloride, thermally decomposes into a mixture of two
colourless gases ammonia and hydrogen chloride.
On cooling the reaction is reversed and solid ammonium chloride reforms.
o This is an example of sublimation but here it involves both physical and chemical changes.
o When a substance sublimes it changes directly from a solid into a gas without melting and on cooling
reforms the solid without condensing to form a liquid.
o
o
o
NH4Cl(s)
NH3(g) + HCl(g)
so the thermal decomposition of ammonium chloride is the forward reaction, and the formation of ammonium
chloride is the backward reaction.
Note:
o
o
o
o
o
Reversing the reaction conditions reverses the direction of chemical change, typical of a reversible
reaction.
Thermal decomposition means using 'heat' to 'break down' a molecule into smaller ones.
The decomposition is endothermic (heat absorbed or heat taken in) and the formation of ammonium
chloride is exothermic (heat released or heat given out).
This means if the direction of chemical change is reversed, the energy change is also reversed.
o
o
o
Ammonium fluoride (>? C), ammonium bromide (>450 C) and ammonium iodide (>550 C), with a
similar formula, all sublime in a similar physical-chemical way when heated, so the equations will be
similar i.e. just swap F, Br or I for the Cl.
o
Similarly, ammonium sulphate also sublimes when heated above 235 C and thermally
decomposes into ammonia gas and sulphuric acid vapour.
(NH4)2SO4(s)
NH3(g) + H2SO4(g)
Ammonium nitrate does not undergo a reversible sublimation reaction, it melts and then
decomposes into nitrogen(I) oxide gas (dinitrogen oxide) and water vapour.
NH4NO3(s)
N2O(g) + 2H2O(g)
This is very different reaction, in fact its an irreversible redox reaction. The nitrate ion, NO3 , or any
nitric acid formed, HNO3, act as an oxidising agent and oxidise the ammonium ion. If the products
are cooled, ammonium nitrate is NOT reformed.
For more on sublimation, see the States of Matter webpage.
The concept of oxidation state can now be fully applied to reactions which do not involve ions e.g.
The oxidation of ammonia via a Pt catalyst at high temperature which is part of the chemistry of nitric acid
manufacture.
4NH3(g) + 5O2(g) ==> 4NO(g) + 6H2O(g)
The oxidation number analysis is:
o 4N at (-3) each in NH3 and 10O all at (0) in O2 change to ...
o 4N at (+2) each in NH3, 4O at (-2) each and 6 O at (-2) each in H2O.
o H is +1 throughout i.e. does not undergo an ox. state change.
o Oxygen is reduced from ox. state (0) to (-2).
o Nitrogen is oxidised from ox. state (-3) to (+2).
o The total increase in ox. state change of 4 x (-3 to +2) for nitrogen is balanced by the total decrease in ox.
state change of 10 x (0 to -2) for oxygen i.e. 20 e or ox. state units change in each case.
o Oxygen is the oxidising agent (gain/accept e s, lowered ox. state) and ammonia is the reducing agent
(loses e s, inc. ox. state of N).
The reaction between ammonium and nitrate(III) (nitrite) ions
Part 8. The p-block elements: 8.4 Group 6/16 oxygen and sulfur in particular
8O
Oxygen
2
Appearance (RTP)
16S
Sulphur
3
34Se
Selenium
4
yellow solid
silver metalloid or
colourless
red powder
(monoclinic/rhombic
gas
allotropes
allotropes)
52Te
Tellurium
84Po
Polonium
(radioactive)
silver white
metalloid
radioactive silvery
solid
-218
117
217
450
254
boiling pt./ C
-183
445
685
990
962
-3
<0.1
2.1
4.8
6.2
9.3
melting pt./ C
density/gcm
-1
1314
1000
941
869
812
73 (cov)
102 (cov)
167 (met)
X ion radius/pm
140
184
198
221
230
electronegativity
3.44
2.58
2.55
2.10
2.00
2,6
2,8,6
2,8,8,6
2,8,18,18,6
2,8,18,32,18,6
electron configuration
[He]2s 2p
principal oxidation
states
atomic covalent or
metallic radius/pm
2-
property\Zsymbol, name
8O
Oxygen
[Ne]3s 3p
Sulphur
10
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
Selenium
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
Tellurium
14
10
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 6p
Polonium
Generally speaking down a p block group the element becomes more metallic in chemical character.
Oxygen and sulphur are non-metals, selenium and tellurium are semi-metals, polonium is essentially a
metal
SO2(aq) + H2O(l)
H (aq) + HSO3 (aq)
o Sulphur trioxide reacts very violently and exothermically to form the oily liquid, strong sulphuric acid.
SO3(g) + H2O(l) ==> H2SO4(l)
In water, the sulphuric acid is almost fully ionised.
+
2 H2SO4(aq) + 2H2O(l) ==> 2H3O (aq) + SO4 (aq)
Reaction of oxide with acids:
o None, only acidic in nature.
Reaction of oxide with bases/alkalis:
o Sulphur dioxide dissolves in strong bases to form sulphites/sulphate(IV)s
o 2NaOH(aq) + SO2(g) ==> Na2SO3(aq) + H2O(l) formation of sodium sulphite/sulphate(IV)
2o ionic equation: 2OH (aq) + SO2(g) ==> SO3 (aq) + H2O(l)
o You would NOT attempt to react sulphur trioxide with water, the reaction is very violent and exothermic.
o but theoretically: 2NaOH(aq) + SO3(g) ==> Na2SO4(aq) + H2O(l)
Reaction of element with chlorine:
o When chlorine is passed over molten sulphur a variety of chlorides are formed.
o The main product is disulphur dichloride
o 2S(s) + Cl2(g) ==> S2Cl2(l) (also SiCl2, SiCl4)
Reaction of chloride with water:
o Slowly hydrolyses in water, via a complex reaction, to form an acid solution of several products (not meant to
be a balanced equation).
S2Cl2(g) + H2O(l) ==> HCl(aq), S(s), SO2(aq), H2SO3(aq), H2SO4(aq), H2S(aq) - complex redox/hydrolysis
reaction!
Reaction of element with water:
o None.
Shapes and bond angles of molecules and ions of oxygen and sulfur
oxygen molecule O2
electrons: 6 bond pairs, OCTAHEDRAL SHAPE: e.g. sulfur(VI) fluoride (sulphur hexafluoride
o
o
molecule) SF6 with Q-X-Q bond angles of 90 and 180 (Q = F, X = S)
Sulphuric acid is used as car battery acid and is used to make fertilisers, dyes and detergents.
o e.g. ammonia + sulphuric acid ==> ammonium sulphate (a fertiliser salt)
o 2NH3(aq) + H2SO4(aq) ==> (NH4)2SO4(aq) => evaporation to get crystals
o Its acid action make it good for cleaning metal surfaces in industry.
Sulphuric acid is manufactured from the raw materials sulphur, air and water and involves the production of
sulphur trioxide in the Contact Process.
(1) Sulfur is burned in air to form sulphur dioxide (exothermic).
o In the reaction the sulphur is oxidised (O gain) (1a) S(s) + O2(g) ==> SO2(g)
o Sulfur dioxide can also be indirectly obtained from the process of extracting copper from copper sulphide
ores e.g. in a copper smelter: (1b) Cu2S(s) + O2(g) ==> 2Cu(l) + SO2(g)
Note: Sulphur dioxide itself is a useful chemical in its own right:
o It is used as a bleach in the manufacture of wood pulp for paper manufacture
o and its toxic nature makes it useful as a food preservative by killing bacteria.
(2) The Contact Process of sulphur trioxide production must be economically efficient for the manufacture
of the important industrial chemical sulphuric acid.
o In the Contact Process reactor the sulphur dioxide is mixed with air (the required stoichiometric volume/mole
SO2:O2 ratio is 2:1, in practice 1-2:1 is used) and the mixture passed over a catalyst of vanadium(V) oxide
V205 at a relatively high temperature of about 450C and at a pressure of between 1-2 atm.
In the reactor the sulphur dioxide is oxidised in the reversible exothermic reaction ...
o
o
2SO3(g)
pSO3
Kp =
------------------2
pSO2 pO2
The reaction forms sulphur trioxide and the equilibrium is very much to the right hand side ...
o The reaction forms sulphur trioxide and the equilibrium is very much to the right hand side because despite
the reaction being exothermic a relatively high temperature is used which favours the reverse reaction
R to L, from the energy change equilibrium rule, i.e. increasing temperature shifts the equilibrium in the
endothermic direction. However the value of Kp is high enough to give a 99% yield.
o The reaction is favoured by high pressure (pressure equilibrium rule, 3 => 2 gas molecules, LHS ==>
RHS), but only a small increase in pressure is used to give high yields of sulphur trioxide, because the
formation of SO3 on the right hand side is so energetically favourable (approx. 99% yield, i.e. only about 1%
SO2 unreacted).
o The use of the V2O5 catalyst ensures a fast reaction without having to use too a higher temperature
which would begin to favour the left hand side too much (energy change equilibrium rule), but remember a
catalyst does not affect the % yield or equilibrium concentration of SO 3, you just get there more economically
faster.
o Multiple reactor beds are used to ensure the maximum % conversion and heat exchange systems
are used to control the temperature, and pre-heat incoming reactant gases.
(3) The sulphur trioxide is dissolved in concentrated sulphuric acid to form fuming sulphuric acid (oleum).
o SO3(g) + H2SO4(l) ==> H2S2O7(l)
(4) Water is then carefully added to the oleum to produce concentrated sulphuric acid (98%).
o H2S2O7(l) + H2O(l) ==> 2H2SO4(l)
o If the sulphur trioxide is added directly to water an acid mist forms which is difficult to contain because the
reaction to form sulphuric acid solution is very exothermic!
o If you 'add' equations (3) + (4) you get
(5) SO3(g) + H2O(l) ==> H2SO4(l)
Good anti-pollution measures need to be in place since the sulphur oxides are harmful and would cause local acid
rain! To help this situation AND help the economics of the process, any unreacted sulphur dioxide is recycled
through the reactor.
A case of disproportionation where an element in a species simultaneously changes into a higher and
lower oxidation state i.e. here two oxygen atoms increase their oxidation state and two oxygen atoms
decrease their oxidation state.
It also means that hydrogen peroxide simultaneously acts as a reducing agent and oxidising agent.
Part 8. The p-block elements: 8.5 Group 0/18 The Noble Gases
2He
helium
10Ne
neon
18Ar
argon
36Kr
krypton
54Xe
86Rn radon
(radioactive)
xenon
-270
-249
-189
-157
-112
-71
-269
-246
-186
-152
-108
-62
0.12
1.21
1.40
2.16
3.50
na
2370
2080
1520
1350
1170
1040
melting point/ C
boiling point/ C
-3
density/gcm (liquid)
1st IE/kJmol
-1
electron configuration
electron configuration
2.8
2
1s
1s 2s 2p
2.8.8
6
[Ne]3s 3p
2.8.18.8
6
10
[Ar]3d 4s 4p
2.8.18.18.8
6
known oxidation states non stable non stable non stable an unstable +2
10
[Kr]4d 5s 5p
2.8.18.32.18.8
6
14
10
+2,4,6,8
na
electronegativity
5.50
4.84
3.20
2.94
2.40
na
atomic covalent
radius/pm
He 49
Ne 51
Ar 94
Kr 109
Xe 130
Rn 136
[Xe]4f 5d 6s 6p
1s
1s 2s 2p
6
2
[Ne]3s 3p
HELIUM The gas is much less dense than air (lighter) and is used in balloons and
'airships'. Because of its inertness it doesn't burn in air UNLIKE hydrogen which used to be used in large
balloons with 'flammable' consequences e.g. like the R101 airship disaster! Helium is also used in gas
mixtures for deep-sea divers.
NEON Neon gives out light when high voltage electricity is passed through it, so its
used in glowing 'neon' advertising signs and fluorescent lights.
ARGON Argon, like all the Noble Gases, is chemically inert. It used in
filament bulbs because the metal filament will not burn in Argon and it reduces evaporation of the metal
filament. It is also used to produce an inert atmosphere in high temperature metallurgical processes, eg in
welding where it reduces brittle oxide formation reducing the weld quality. Its bubbles are used to stir
mixtures in steel production. Argon is the cheapest to produce.
KRYPTON Not used by superman! BUT is used in fluorescent bulbs, flash bulbs and laser beams.
XENON used in fluorescent bulbs, flash bulbs and lasers.
o
o
cause cell damage (DNA) and ultimately cancer (see link below). However it is used in some forms of cancer
treatment.
NOBLE GAS COMPOUNDS - yes they do exist!
o From the early 1960's compounds have been made, but only xenon compounds are stable and usually
combined with oxygen and fluorine, which, not surprisingly, are the more reactive non-metals e.g.
o
o Xe(g) + 2F2(g) => XeF4(g) (using Ni catalyst 60 C)
The molecule has a square planar shape.
o There is now quite an extensive chemistry of xenon e.g.
xenon(II) fluoride XeF2 (linear), xenon(VI) fluoride XeF6
xenon(VI) oxide (xenon trioxide) XeO3 which has a trigonal pyramid shape
xenon oxytetrafluoride XeOF4 (Xe ox. st. +6)
4 the xenonate(VIII) ion XeO6 ion exists in salts such as Na4XeO6.8H2O which is stable and can be
crystallised as a hydrated salt from aqueous solution.
o I don't know of any stable compound of helium and argon, but argon(II) fluoride ArF 2 has been prepared at
o
low temperatures (<40K, <-233 C, via uv light shone onto frozen argon in the presence of fluorine?).
o Krypton(II) fluoride KrF2 and krypton(IV) fluoride KrF4 have been prepared, despite the great reluctance of
krypton to react - but we are dealing with fluorine, the most reactive element known and one of the most
powerful oxidising agents known.